Samsung SL-M4580FX User Manual

User’s Guide
BASIC
BASIC
This guide provides information concerning installation, basic operation and
troubleshooting on Windows.
ADVANCED (ADMINISTRATOR’S GUIDE)
This administrator’s guide provides advanced information for administrator’s to use and
manage the machine.
Some features may not be available depending on model or country.
BASIC
1. Introduction
Key benefits
6
Features by model
8
Useful to know
13
About this user’s guide
14
Safety information
15
Machine overview
20
Control panel overview
23
Connecting a network cable
24
Turning on the machine
25
Understanding the LEDs
26
Display screen and useful menu
29
Understanding the pop-up keyboard
38
Installing the driver locally
39
Reinstalling the driver
42
2. Media and Tray
Printing on special media
55
Setting the paper size and type
59
Selecting an output location
61
3. Printing
Printer driver features
63
Basic printing
64
Opening printing preferences
66
Using special print features
74
Using direct printing utility
82
Changing the default print settings
84
Setting your machine as a default machine
85
Printing to a file (PRN)
86
Mac printing
87
Linux printing
89
Unix printing
91
4. Copying
Loading originals
45
Selecting print media
49
Loading paper in the tray
50
Understanding the copy screen
94
Basic copying
103
Quick copying
104
2
BASIC
ID card copying
105
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
149
8. Management Tools
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
108
Accessing management tools
158
Basic scan
116
SyncThru™ Web Service
159
Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software
117
Easy Capture Manager
166
Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
118
Samsung AnyWeb Print
167
Mac scanning
120
Easy Eco Driver
168
Linux scanning
121
Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
169
Using Samsung Easy Printer Manager
170
Using Samsung Printer Status
173
Using Samsung Printer Experience
175
Using Box
181
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
Preparing to fax
123
Using a fax in your computer
124
Understanding the fax screen
126
Sending a fax
135
Receiving a fax
137
7. Setting up an Address Book
9. Troubleshooting
Redistributing toner
185
Replacing the toner cartridge
187
Replacing the imaging unit
189
Tips for avoiding paper jams
191
Understanding the address screen
143
Clearing jams
192
Using the control panel
145
Understanding display messages
208
3
BASIC
Power and cable connecting problems
213
Solving other problems
214
10. Supplies and Accessories
Ordering supplies and accessories
233
Available consumables
234
Available accessories
235
Available maintenance parts
236
Installing accessories
237
Checking replaceable’s lifespan
241
Using a USB Drive device
242
11. Appendix
Specifications
247
Regulatory information
257
Copyright
269
4
1. Introduction
These are the main components of your machine:
This chapter includes:
• Key benefits
6
• Features by model
8
• Useful to know
13
• About this user’s guide
14
• Safety information
15
• Machine overview
20
• Control panel overview
23
• Connecting a network cable
24
• Turning on the machine
25
• Understanding the LEDs
26
• Display screen and useful menu
29
• Understanding the pop-up keyboard
38
• Installing the driver locally
39
• Reinstalling the driver
42
Key benefits
Environmentally friendly
Convenience
• To save toner and paper, this machine supports Eco feature .
• To save paper, you can print multiple pages on one single sheet of paper .
• You can print on the go from your smartphone or computer using Google
Cloud Print™ enabled apps.
• To save paper, you can print on both sides of the paper (double-sided
printing).
• Easy Capture Manager allows you to easily edit and print whatever you
captured using the Print Screen key on the keyboard.
• To save electricity, this machine automatically conserves electricity by
substantially reducing power consumption when not in use.
• Samsung Easy Printer Manager and Printing Status is a program that
monitors and informs you of the machine’s status and allows you to
customize the machine’s settings.
• We recommend using recycled paper for saving energy.
Fast high resolution printing
• Samsung Easy Document Creator is an application to help users scan,
compile, and save documents in multiple formats, including .epub format.
These documents can be shared via social networking sites or fax.
• AnyWeb Print helps you screen-capture, preview, scrap, and print the
screen of Windows Internet Explorer more easily than when you use the
ordinary program.
• Smart Update allows you to check for the latest software and install the
latest version during the printer driver installation process. This is available
only for Windows.
• You can print with a resolution of Up to 1200 x 1200 dpi effective output
(1200 x 600 x 2 bit).
• Fast, on-demand printing.
For single-side printing, up to 45 ppm (A4) or up to 47 ppm (Letter).
• If you have Internet access, you can get help, support application, machine
drivers, manuals, and order information from the Samsung website,
www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or Downloads.
Key benefits
Wide range of functionality and application support
• Supports various paper sizes .
• Print watermark: You can customize your documents with words, such as
“Confidential” .
• You can print in various operating systems .
• Your machine is equipped with a USB interface and/or a network interface.
Support XOA applications
The machine supports XOA custom applications.
• Regarding the XOA custom applications, please contact your XOA custom
application provider.
Features by model
Some features and optional goods may not be available depending on model or country.
Operating System
Operating System
M458x series
Windows
●
Mac
●
Linux
●
Unix
●
(●: Included, Blank: Not available)
Software
You can install the printer driver and software when you insert the software CD into your CD-ROM drive. For windows, select the printer driver and software
in the Select Software to Install window.
Software
M458x series
SPL printer driver
PCL printer driver
●
PS printer drivera
●
XPS printer drivera
●
Features by model
Software
●
Direct Printing Utilitya
Samsung Easy Printer Manager
M458x series
Scan to PC Settings
●
Fax to PC Settings
●
Device Settings
●
Samsung Printer Status
●
Samsung AnyWeb Printa
●
Samsung Easy Document Creator
●
Easy Capture Manager
●
SyncThru™ Web Service
●
SyncThru Admin Web Service
●
Easy Eco Driver
●
Fax
Samsung Network PC Fax
●
Scan
Twain scan driver
●
a. Download the software from the Samsung website and install it: (http://www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or Downloads). Before installing,
check whether your computer’s OS support the software.
(●: Supported, Blank: Not supported)
Features by model
Variety feature
Features
M458x series
Hi-Speed USB 2.0
●
Network Interface Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base TX wired LAN
●
Network Interface 802.11b/g/n wireless LANa
○
Google Cloud Print™
●
AirPrint
●
Wireless/NFC kit
○
Eco printing
●
Duplex (2-sided) printing
●
USB Drive deviceb
●
Memory module
○
Optional tray (SCF)
○
Short Stand
○
Document
Feeder
Dual Scan Document Feeder (DSDF)
Automatic Document Feeder (ADF)
●
Features by model
Features
Fax
Scan
M458x series
Multi-send
●
Delay send
●
Duplex send
●
Secure receive
●
Duplex print
●
Scanning to email
●
Scanning to SMB server
●
Scanning to FTP server
●
Scan to PC
●
Scan to USB
●
Duplex scan
●
Features by model
Features
Copy
M458x series
ID card copying
●
Reduced or enlarged copying
●
Booklet
●
Poster
●
Imaging Repeat
●
Watermark
●
Stamp
●
N-up
●
Erase Edge
●
Overlay
●
Image Shift
●
Duplex copy
●
a. Depending on your country, wireless LAN card may not be available. For some countries, only 802.11 b/g can be applied. Contact your
local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you bought your machine.
b. You can only print files stored on a USB Drive device.
(●: Supported, ○: Optional, Blank: Not supported)
Useful to know
The machine does not print.
A paper jam has occurred.
• Open the print queue list and remove the document from the
list .
• Open and close the cover (see "Front view" on page 21).
• Remove the driver and install it again (see "Installing the driver
locally" on page 39).
• Select your machine as your default machine in your Windows .
• Check the instructions on removing jammed paper in this
manual and troubleshoot accordingly.
Printouts are blurry.
Where can I purchase accessories or supplies?
• The toner level might be low or uneven. Shake the toner
cartridge .
• Inquire at a Samsung distributor or your retailer.
• Try a different print resolution setting.
• Visit www.samsung.com/supplies. Select your country/region
to view product service information.
• Replace the toner cartridge .
Where can I download the machine’s driver?
The status LED flashes or remains constantly on.
• Turn the product off and on again.
• Check the meanings of LED indications in this manual and
troubleshoot accordingly (see "Understanding the LEDs" on
page 26).
• You can get help, support application, machine drivers,
manuals, and order information from the Samsung website,
www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or
Downloads.
About this user’s guide
This user's guide provides information for your basic understanding of the
machine as well as detailed steps to explain machine usage.
•
Do not discard this manual and keep it for future reference.
•
Read the safety information before using the machine.
•
If you have a problem using the machine, refer to the troubleshooting
chapter.
•
•
2
General icons
Icon
Text
Caution
Terms used in this user’s guide are explained in the glossary chapter.
All illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending
on its options or model you purchased.
•
The screenshots/some menus in this user’s guide may differ from your
machine depending on the machine’s firmware/driver version.
•
The procedures in this user’s guide are mainly based on Windows 7.
Warning
Note
Description
Gives users information to protect the machine from
possible mechanical damage or malfunction.
Used to alert users to the possibility of personal injury.
Provides additional information or detailed
specification of the machine function and feature.
1
Conventions
Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below:
•
Document is synonymous with original.
•
Paper is synonymous with media, or print media.
•
Machine refers to printer or MFP.
1. Introduction
14
Safety information
These warnings and precautions are included to prevent injury to you and
others, and to prevent any potential damage to your machine. Be sure to read
and understand all of these instructions before using the machine. After reading
this section, keep it in a safe place for future reference.
4
Operating environment
Warning
3
Important safety symbols
Do not use if the power cord is damaged or if the electrical outlet is
not grounded.
Explanation of all icons and signs used in this chapter
Warning
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in severe
personal injury or death.
Caution
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in minor
personal injury or property damage.
Do not attempt.
This could result in electric shock or fire.
Do not place anything on top of the machine (water, small metal or
heavy objects, candles, lit cigarettes, etc.).
This could result in electric shock or fire.
• If the machine gets overheated, it releases smoke, makes strange
noises, or generates an odd odor, immediately turn off the power
switch and unplug the machine.
• The user should be able to access the power outlet in case of
emergencies that might require the user to pull the plug out.
This could result in electric shock or fire.
Do not bend, or place heavy objects on the power cord.
Stepping on or allowing the power cord to be crushed by a heavy
object could result in electric shock or fire.
Do not remove the plug by pulling on the cord; do not handle the
plug with wet hands.
This could result in electric shock or fire.
1. Introduction
15
Safety information
5
Caution
During an electrical storm or for a period of non-operation,
remove the power plug from the electrical outlet.
Operating method
Caution
This could result in electric shock or fire.
Be careful, the paper output area is hot.
Do not forcefully pull the paper out during printing.
Burns could occur.
It can cause damage to the machine.
If the machine has been dropped, or if the cabinet appears
damaged, unplug the machine from all interface connections and
request assistance from qualified service personnel.
Be careful not to put your hand between the machine and paper
tray.
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.
You may get injured.
If the machine does not operate properly after these instructions
have been followed, unplug the machine from all interface
connections and request assistance from qualified service
personnel.
Be careful when replacing paper or removing jammed paper.
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.
If the plug does not easily enter the electrical outlet, do not
attempt to force it in.
Call an electrician to change the electrical outlet, or this could
result in electric shock.
Do not allow pets to chew on the AC power, telephone or PC
interface cords.
New paper has sharp edges and can cause painful cuts.
When printing large quantities, the bottom part of the paper
output area may get hot. Do not allow children to touch.
Burns can occur.
When removing jammed paper, do not use tweezers or sharp metal
objects.
It can damage the machine.
Do not allow too many papers to stack up in the paper output tray.
It can damage the machine.
This could result in electric shock or fire and/or injury to your pet.
1. Introduction
16
Safety information
Do not block or push objects into the ventilation opening.
Caution
This could result in elevated component temperatures which can
cause damage or fire.
Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other
than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation
exposure.
This machine's power reception device is the power cord.
To switch off the power supply, remove the power cord from the
electrical outlet.
Before moving the machine, turn the power off and disconnect all
cords. The information below are only suggestions based on the
units weight.If you have a medical condition that prevents you
from lifting, do not lift the machine. Ask for help, and always use
the appropriate amount of people to lift the device safety.
Then lift the machine:
• If the machine weighs under 20 kg (44.09 lbs), lift with 1 person.
• If the machine weighs 20 kg (44.09 lbs) - 40kg (88.18 lbs), lift
with 2 people.
6
Installation / Moving
• If the machine weighs more than 40 kg (88.18 lbs), lift with 4 or
more people.
The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage.
Warning
Do not place the machine in an area with dust, humidity, or water
leaks.
This could result in electric shock or fire.
Place the machine in the environment where it meets the
operating temperature and humidity specification.
Otherwise, quality problems can occur and cause damage to the
machine.
Choose a flat surface with enough space for ventilation to place
the machine. Also consider the space required to open the cover
and trays.
The place should be well-ventilated and be far from direct light,
heat, and humidity.
When using the machine for a long period of time or printing a
large number of pages in a non-ventilated space, it could pollute
the air and be harmful to your health. Place the machine in a wellventilated space or open a window to circulate the air periodically.
Do not place the machine on an unstable surface.
The machine could fall, causing injury or machine damage.
1. Introduction
17
Safety information
7
Use only No.26 AWGa or larger, telephone line cord, if necessary.
Maintenance / Checking
Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine.
Make sure you plug the power cord into a grounded electrical
outlet.
Caution
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.
Use the power cord supplied with your machine for safe
operation. If you are using a cord which is longer than 2 meters (6
feet) with a 110V machine, then the gauge should be 16 AWG or
larger.
Otherwise, it can cause damage to the machine, and could result
in electric shock or fire.
Do not put a cover over the machine or place it in an airtight
location, such as a closet.
If the machine is not well-ventilated, this could result in fire.
Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords.
This can diminish performance, and could result in electric shock
or fire.
The machine should be connected tothe power level which is
specified on the label.
If you are unsure and want to check the power level you are using,
contact the electrical utility company.
a. AWG: American Wire Gauge
Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning the
inside of the machine. Do not clean the machine with benzene,
paint thinner or alcohol; do not spray water directly into the
machine.
This could result in electric shock or fire.
When you are working inside the machine replacing
consumables or cleaning the inside, do not operate the machine.
You could get injured.
Keep cleaning consumables away from children.
Children could get hurt.
Do not disassemble, repair or rebuild the machine by yourself.
It can damage the machine. Call a certified technician when the
machine needs repairing.
To clean and operate the machine, strictly follow the user's guide
provided with the machine.
Otherwise, you could damage the machine.
1. Introduction
18
Safety information
Keep the power cable and the contact surface of the plug clean
from dust or water.
When storing consumables such as toner cartridges, keep them
away from children.
Otherwise, this could result in electric shock or fire.
Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested.
• Do not remove any covers or guards that are fastened with
screws.
Using recycled consumables, such as toner, can cause damage to
the machine.
• Fuser units should only be repaired by a certified service
technician. Repair by non-certified technicians could result in
fire or electric shock.
In case of damage due to the use of recycled consumables, a
service fee will be charged.
• The machine should only be repaired by a Samsung service
technician.
For consumables that contain toner dust (toner cartridge, waste
toner bottle, imaging unit, etc.) follow the instructions below.
• When disposing of the consumables, follow the instructions
for disposal. Refer to the reseller for disposal instructions.
8
Supply usage
Caution
Do not disassemble the toner cartridge.
Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested.
Do not burn any of the consumables such as toner cartridge or
fuser unit.
This could cause an explosion or uncontrollable fire.
• Do not wash the consumables.
• For a waste toner bottle, do not reuse it after emptying the
bottle.
If you do not follow the instructions above, it may cause machine
malfunction and environmental pollution. The warranty does not
cover damages caused by a user's carelessness.
When toner gets on your clothing, do not use hot water to wash
it.
Hot water sets toner into fabric. Use cold water.
When changing the toner cartridge or removing jammed paper,
be careful not to let toner dust touch your body or clothes.
Toner dust can be dangerous if inhaled or ingested.
1. Introduction
19
Machine overview
9
Components
The actual component may differ from the illustration below. Some components may change depending on the circumstances.
Machine
Imaging unit
Power cord
Quick installation guide
Software CDa
Misc. accessoriesb
a. The software CD contains the print drivers, user’s guide, and software applications.
b. Miscellaneous accessories included with your machine may vary by country of purchase and specific model.
1. Introduction
20
Machine overview
10
3
Front view
Dual scan document feeder input tray
15 Push-release of Multi-purpose
tray
4
Dual scan document feeder output
tray
14
5
Control panel
16 Front cover release button
6
Control board cover
17 Output tray
7
Front cover
18 Output support tray
8
Handle
19 USB Drive device port
9
Optional traya
20 Scanner glass
Multi-purpose tray
10 Stand
21 Scanner lid
11 Paper level indicator
22 Control panel unlock button
a. Optional feature
1
Dual scan document feeder cover
12 Tray handle
2
Dual scan document feeder width
guides
13
Tray 1
1. Introduction
21
Machine overview
11
12
Inner view
Rear view
1
Toner cartridge
1 Wireless/NFC kita port cover
6
Network port
2
Imaging unit
2 Rear cover handle
7
EDI port for card reader
3
Multi-purpose support tray
3 Rear cover
8
USB port
4
Paper width guides on a multi-purpose tray
4 Extension telephone socket
(EXT.)
9
5 Telephone line socket (LINE)
10
If you want to see the imaging unit, you need to remove the toner cartridge.
Power-switch
Power receptacle
a. Optional feature.
1. Introduction
22
Control panel overview
13
When you use the display screen, use your finger only. The screen may be
damaged with a sharp pen or anything else.
Control panel
14
Adusting angle of the control panel
You can adjust the angle of the control panel for your convenience. Refer to the
illustration below.
When moving or storing the machine, press the unlock button to fold down
the control panel. The unlock button is located on the top side of the control
panel.
1
2
Display screen
Shows the current machine status and prompts
during an operation. You can set menus easily using
the display screen.
a. Power LED
Shows the power status of your machine.
b.
(Power /
Wakeup) button
3
Status LED
Turn the power on or off. When the blue LED is on, the
machine is powered on and you can use it. If you turn
the machine off, press this button for more than two
seconds, and then confirmation window appears.
Shows the status of your machine (see
"Understanding the LEDs" on page 26).
1. Introduction
23
Connecting a network cable
This machine has a bulit-in network interface card. You can connect your
machine to a network using a network cable.
1. Introduction
24
Turning on the machine
Keep in mind that you should use the power cord supplied with the
machine. Otherwise, it can cause damage or fire to the machine.
Connect the machine to the electricity supply first.
You can also turn the machine on pressing the
(Power / Wakeup)
• Some parts inside of the machine may be hot when power is on, or after
printing. Be careful not to burn yourself when working inside the
machine.
• Do not disassemble the machine when it is turned on or plugged in.
Doing so may give you an electric shock.
• If you turn the machine off directly using the power switch, it could cause
the hard disk problem in the machine.
1. Introduction
25
Understanding the LEDs
The color of the status LED indicates the machine's current status.
• Some LEDs may not be available depending on model or country (see "Control panel overview" on page 23).
• To resolve the error, look at the error message and its instructions from the troubleshooting part .
• You also can resolve the error with the guideline from the computers’ Samsung Printer Status program window .
• If the problem persists, call a service representative.
15
Status LED
Status
Off
Description
• The machine is off-line.
• The machine is in power save mode.
Blue
On
The machine is on-line and can be used.
Blinking
Fax
The machine is sending or receiving faxes.
Copy
The machine is copying documents.
Scan
The machine is scanning documents.
Print
• When the status LED slowly blinks, the machine is receiving data from the computer.
• When the status LED blinks rapidly, the machine is printing data.
1. Introduction
26
Understanding the LEDs
Status
Red
On
Description
• A toner cartridge has almost reached its estimated cartridge lifea. It is recommended to replace the toner cartridge.
• A paper jam has occurred .
• The cover is opened. Close the cover.
• There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in the tray.
• The machine has stopped due to a major error. Check the display message.
• An imaging unit has almost reached its estimated cartridge lifea. It is recommended to replace the imaging unit.
Blinking
• A minor error has occurred and the machine is waiting for the error to be cleared. Check the display message. When the problem is cleared,
the machine resumes its original task.
• The toner cartridge or imaging unit is near the end of its lifea. Order a new toner cartridge or imaging unit. You can temporarily improve print
quality by redistributing the toner.
a. Estimated cartridge life means the expected or estimated toner cartridge life, which indicates the average capacity of print-outs and is designed pursuant to ISO/IEC 19752. The number of pages
may be affected by operating environment, percentage of image area, printing interval, graphics, media and media size.
Check the message on the display screen. Follow the instructions in the message or refer to the troubleshooting chapter (see ). If the problem persists, call for service.
1. Introduction
27
Understanding the LEDs
16
Power LED
The color of the status LED indicates the machine's current status.
Status
Off
Blue
Description
The machine is off-line.
On
The machine is on-line and can be used.
Blinking
The machine is in power save mode. When data is received, or any screen is pressed, it switches to on-line automatically.
Check the message on the display screen. Follow the instructions in the message or refer to the troubleshooting chapter. If the problem persists, call for service.
1. Introduction
28
Display screen and useful menu
Swipe
17
Menu navigation
You can tailor the machine’s range of functions to fit your needs with both
menus and widgets. Access features by scrolling through the available onscreen menus.
Lightly drag your finger across the screen.
For example:
•
Swipe up or down on a home screen or menu to scroll it.
Panning
Manual terms
Touch and hold an icon, and then tilt the device left or right.
For example:
Tap
•
Lightly touch the screen and release your finger.
Use panning to move icons from your home screens or application menus
to other pages.
For example:
•
Tap the on-screen keyboard to enter characters or other text.
•
Tap a menu item to select it.
•
Tap an application’s icon to launch the application.
Command Keys
•
(Back): Return to the previous screen, option or step.
•
(Home): Go to the main home screen
Touch and hold
•
(Recent): Show recently used apps.
Lightly touch and hold your finger to the screen.
•
Quick launch: A customizable key. See the next section for options.
For example:
•
Touch and hold a widget on the home screen to move it.
•
Touch and hold on a field to display a pop-up menu of options.
1. Introduction
29
Display screen and useful menu
Add quick launch
1
From the display screen, tap the Settings (
Settings > Quick Launch.
2
Select the desired quick launch function.
3
•
None: The icon is not shown.
•
Screen Capture (
•
Applications (
•
Search (
Tap
) icon > Display > More
Depending on authentication settings, a machine’s users may need to enter
an ID and password. If this is enabled, the machine can only be used by a
user with an authorized ID and password on the machine. Contact the
machine’s administrator.
Navigating the home screens
): Capture the current screen to an image file.
): Open a screen showing all apps.
The machine initially has three home screens. You can place application icons on
any page.
): Open the search screen.
(Back) to return to the settings menu.
From the main home screen, swipe left or right. The main home screen is
located in the center and three additional pages are located on each side.
18
Home screen overview
The main home screen is the starting point for many applications and functions.
You can customize it with application icons, shortcuts, and widgets to give you
instant access to information and applications. You can open the default page
at any time by tapping the
Navigating the application menus
By default, this machine has several application menus available in the main
home screen. If you want to access all application menus and widgets, tap the
icon and swipe the screen left or right.
icon. The screen images in this user guide may
differ from your machine depending on its options or model.
From the main home screen, swipe left or right. The main home screen is
located in the center.
1. Introduction
30
Display screen and useful menu
Accessing recently-used apps
You can easily find any app that you used recently.
1
Tap the
icon from anywhere to open the recently-used
applications window.
2
Tap an application’s icon in this window to open it.
Adding a shortcut from the home screen
1
2
Tap the
Touch and hold the home screen to view a list of available shortcuts to
select from.
•
19
Customizing your home screen
Set wallpaper
-
Home Screen : Set the wallpaper for the Home Screen.
-
Login Screen : Set the wallpaper for the Login Screen. To use
this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator .
-
Home and Login Screens : Set the wallpaper for both screens.
To use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator .
You can customize your home screen to suit your needs.
Creating shortcuts
Shortcuts are different from widgets. While widgets can only launch
applications, shortcuts can do this and activate features and actions.
icon to go to the main home screen.
•
Apps, XOA Apps, Widgets and Programs : Place apps, XOA apps,
widgets, and program icons on home screen.
•
Folder : Create a folder on the home screen.
•
Page : Add another page to the home screen.
Adding a shortcut from the Apps menu
1
2
3
Tap the
icon to go to the main home screen.
Tap the
icon to view your current applications.
Scroll through the list and locate the desired application.
1. Introduction
31
Display screen and useful menu
4
5
Touch and hold the application icon. This creates a shortcut to the
application and shows the main home screen.
Drag the shortcut to a desired position on the screen and release it. To
move to a different page, drag the shortcut to the edge of the screen
until the screen scrolls to the desired page.
Deleting a shortcut
1
2
Adding a widget
1
2
3
4
Tap the
5
Drag the widget to the desired position on the screen and release it. To
move the widget to a different page, drag it to the edge of the screen
until the screen scrolls to the desired page.
Touch and hold a shortcut until it becomes movable.
You can drag shortcut and place a shortcut in the trash, both items turn
red.
This action does not uninstall a program, it only removes the shortcut from
the home screen.
Adding and removing widgets
Widgets are self-contained applications that reside on your widgets tab and on
any page of the home screen. Unlike shortcuts, a widget appears as an on-screen
application.
Tap the
icon to go to the main home screen.
icon and tap the Widget tap at the top of the screen.
Scroll through the list and locate your desired widget.
Touch and hold the widget icon. This creates a copy of the widget and
opens the main home screen.
Removing a widget
1
2
Touch and hold a widget until it becomes movable.
You can drag shortcut and place a shortcut in the trash, both items turn
red.
This action does not uninstall a widget, it only removes the copy from the
home screen.
1. Introduction
32
Display screen and useful menu
Moving icons in the Apps menu
3
Tap one of the following options in the next window that appears.
•
1
2
3
4
Tap the
icon to go to the main home screen.
Tap the
icon to view your current applications.
Gallery: Select a wallpaper from photographs and images in the
machine’s gallery.
You can select any images in a USB device or the 'BOX > Download' folder.
Tap the Apps tab at the top of the screen if it is not already selected.
Drag the icon to a desired position on the screen and release it. To move
to a different page, drag the icon to the edge of the screen until the
screen scrolls to the desired page.
4
•
Live wallpapers: Select an animated image.
•
Wallpapers: Select from several built-in stationary images.
Select a wallpaper and tap Set wallpaper, or Cancel.
Changing the Wallpaper
You can customize the Wallpaper (background) of your home screens.
1
From any home screen, touch and hold on an empty area of the screen,
and then select Set wallpaper option.
2
Tap one of the following options in the window that appears.
•
Home Screen : Set the wallpaper for the Home Screen.
•
Login Screen : Set the wallpaper for the Login Screen. To use this
feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator.
•
Home and Login Screens : Set the wallpaper for both screens. To
use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator.
1. Introduction
33
Display screen and useful menu
20
21
Notification Bar
The notification bar includes a pull-down list to show information about
currently running processes, toner status, screen brightness, and recent
notifications.
Job Status
When you tap Job Status from the home screen or Apps, the screen lists
Current Job, Completed Job, Secure Print, Secure Fax and Active Notice.
Current Job
Displays a list of jobs in progress and pending.
Completed Job
Displays a list of the completed jobs, including information about jobs in which
an error has occurred.
Secured Print / Fax
On the home screen, touch and hold the notification bar until the pull-down
appears, and then drag down to expand it.
Displays a list of secured jobs. For secured print, you need to enter the ID and
Password set in the printer driver. For secured fax, you need to enter the
Password.
Active Notice
Displays any error messages and codes that have occurred.
1. Introduction
34
Display screen and useful menu
Command keys
22
Counter
Button
You can check how many pages/jobs were printed, copied, scanned, and faxedout. You can check the counter by device or users.
Tap Counter from the home screen or Apps.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Information tab
> Usage Counters (see "Counter" on page 35).
All
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menu.
Search
Search for a desired menu or app.
Print
You can print a usage counter report.
My Program
Open a list of the apps you added.
Period
Select the period of checking counter.
From, To
Set the period of checking counter.
Understanding the Counter menu
•
Total Usage: Each category shows the usage count by job types ( Print,
Copy, Fax Print, Report, Total ).
-
All : Tap and select
•
Send Usage: Shows the count of Send ( Email, SMB, FTP, USB, PC, Others)
jobs.
•
Fax Send Usage(PSTN): Shows the count of Fax Send Usage.
•
User Usage (Login user only): Each category shows the printing usage by
user.
1. Introduction
35
Display screen and useful menu
1
To use User Usage, you may need to select to Application Authentication
and Stanard Accounting Only from Settings > Admin Settings > Security
> Mode or Method on the home screen or Apps.
Tap Help from the home screen or Apps.
The Help screen is displayed.
2
23
Select a topic and follow the built-in navigation.
Click the
USB
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu), and then
click on any option you want to know about.
To use the USB feature, tap Box > USB on the home screen or Apps.
25
To use this feature, you need to insert a USB Drive device into the USB port
on your machine.
24
Help
My Page
The My Page app allows you to easily change your profile information and
settings. Your My Page profile stores your contact information as well as your
personal settings. You can use these settings to personalize the machine to suit
your usage habits and accessibility needs.
Help provides online information to help with your machine questions.
The Help app provides information about the menus and functions available in
the machine. Use the pane on the left side of the screen to navigate the Help
app. You can also select the headings below each section to browse the help
topics.
1. Introduction
36
Display screen and useful menu
To use this feature, tap My Page on the home screen or Apps.
Button
Name
Description
Change
Password
Allows you to change the password.
Profile Image
Allows you to choose an image for your profile.
Understanding the My Page menu
Allows you to modify various settings to make your experience using the
machine more enjoyable.
•
Personalization
-
Command keys
•
Button
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menu.
Search
Search for a desired menu or app.
My Program
Open a list of the apps you added.
Usage: The Frequency of Usage graph shows how many print, copy, fax,
send, or other jobs you have performed, while the quota information
indicates how close you are to your usage quotas.
Apps Settings
-
+Me Setting: The +Me Setting setting specifies whether or not the
machine sends information about your usage to the Box or another
destination. You can also specify where your usage information is sent.
-
Send Feedback: The Send Feedback setting specifies whether or not
the machine sends information about your usage to the manufacturer.
Sending feedback helps the manufacturer improve the machine
through updates or patches.
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow)
1. Introduction
37
Understanding the pop-up keyboard
You can enter letters, numbers, or special symbols using the pop-up keyboard
on the display screen. This keyboard uses the standard QWERTY layout for ease
of use.
When you touch an input area, the keyboard pops up on the screen. The
keyboard initially shows lowercase letters.
•
Shift key(
): Tap this key to enter one upper-case letter. Tap this key
twice to toggle caps-lock.
•
Symbol/Numeric Mode(
and emoticons.
•
ABC Mode(
): Tap this key to return the keyboard layout to the
default letter keys. Use the Shift key (
and upper-case letters.
•
Space bar(
) to toggle between lower-case
): Tap this key to enter a space.
): Tap this key to enter numbers, symbols,
1. Introduction
38
Installing the driver locally
A locally connected machine is a machine directly attached to your computer
using the cable. If your machine is attached to a network, skip the following
steps below and go on to installing a network connected machine’s driver.
26
Windows
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.
• The installation window in this User’s Guide may differ depending on the
machine and interface in use.
• Only use a USB cable no longer than 3 meters (118 inches).
If the installation window does not appear, click Start > All programs >
Accessories > Run.
X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter, which represents your CDROM drive and click OK.
•
For Windows 8,
If the installation window does not appear, from Charms, select
Search > Apps and search for Run. Type in X:\Setup.exe, replacing
“X” with the letter that represents your CD-ROM drive and click OK.
If “Tap to choose what happens with this disc.” pop-up window
appears, click the window and select Run Setup.exe.
3
Review and accept the installation agreements in the installation
window, and then click Next.
1. Introduction
39
Installing the driver locally
4
5
Select USB on the Printer Connection Type screen, and then click Next.
Follow the instructions in the installation window.
From the Windows 8 Start Screen
27
Mac
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.
3
Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Mac desktop.
• The V4 driver is automatically downloaded from the Windows Update if your computer
is connected to the Internet. If not, you can manually download the V4 driver from
Samsung website, www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or downloads.
•
•
You can download Samsung Printer Experience app from the Windows Store. You need
have a Microsoft account to use the Windows Store.
1 From Charms, select Search.
2 Click Store.
3 Search and click Samsung Printer Experience.
4 Click Install.
If you install the driver using the supplied software CD, V4 driver is not installed. If you
want to use the V4 driver in the Desktop screen, you can download from the Samsung
website, www.samsung.com >find your product > Support or downloads.
• If you want to install Samsung’s printer management tools, you need to install them
using the supplied software CD.
1
Make sure that your computer is connected to the Internet and powered
on.
2
3
Make sure that the machine is powered on.
Connect the computer and the machine with a USB cable.
The driver is automatically installed from the Windows Update.
•
4
5
6
7
8
For Mac OS X 10.8, double-click the CD-ROM that appears on Finder.
Double-click the MAC_Installer folder > Installer OS X icon.
Click Continue.
Read the license agreement and click Continue.
Click Agree to agree to the license agreement.
Click Install. All components necessary for machine operations will be
installed.
If you click Customize, you can choose individual components to install.
1. Introduction
40
Installing the driver locally
9
10
Enter the password and click OK (or Install Software).
11
Click Add Printer button to select your printer and add it to your printer
list.
12
13
Click Continue.
Select USB Connected Printer on the Printer Connection Type and
click Continue.
After the installation is finished, click Close.
28
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
3
Copy Unified Linux Driver package to your system.
4
5
6
Extract the package.
7
8
Proceed with installation.
Linux
You need to download Linux software packages from the Samsung website to
install the printer software (http://www.samsung.com > find your product >
Support or Downloads).
Installing the Unified Linux Driver
You must log in as a super user (root) to install the machine software. If you
are not a super user, ask your system administrator.
9
10
11
Open Terminal program and go to the folder that you copied the
package to.
Move to uld folder.
Execute "./install.sh" command (If you're not logged in as root, execute
the command with "sudo" as "sudo ./install.sh")
When installation finished, launch printing utility(Go to System >
Administration > Printing or execute "system-config-printer"
command in Terminal program).
Click Add button.
Select your printer.
Click Forward button and add it to your system.
1. Introduction
41
Reinstalling the driver
If the printer driver does not work properly, follow the steps below to reinstall
the driver.
4
Insert the software CD into your CD-ROM drive and install the driver
again (see "Installing the driver locally" on page 39).
29
Windows
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs > Samsung
Printers > Uninstall Samsung Printer Software.
•
For Windows 8,
1 From Charms, select Search > Apps.
From the Windows 8 Start Screen
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
Click on the Uninstall Samsung Printer Software tile in the Start
screen.
3
Follow the instructions in the window.
2 Search and click Control Panel.
3 Click Programs and Features.
4 Right-click the driver you want to uninstall and select Uninstall.
5 Follow the instructions in the window.
3
Follow the instructions in the installation window.
• If you cannot find a Samsung Printer Software tile, uninstall from the
desktop screen mode.
• If you want to uninstall Samsung’s printer management tools, from the
Start screen, right-click the app > Uninstall > right-click the program
you want to delete > Uninstall and follow the instruction in the window.
1. Introduction
42
Reinstalling the driver
30
31
Mac
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it.
1
2
3
4
5
Open the Applications folder > Samsung > Printer Software
Uninstaller.
To uninstall printer software, click Continue.
Check the program you want to delete and click Uninstall.
Enter the password and click OK.
Linux
If the printer driver does not work properly, uninstall the driver and reinstall it.
1
2
3
Open Terminal program.
4
Proceed with uninstallation.
Move to uld folder extracted from Unified Linux Driver package.
Execute "./uninstall.sh" command (If you're not logged in as root,
execute the command with "sudo" as "sudo ./uninstall.sh")
After the uninstallation is finished, click Close.
If a machine has already been added, delete it from the Print Setup Utility
or Print & Fax.
1. Introduction
43
2. Media and Tray
This chapter provides information on how to load originals and print media into your machine.
This chapter includes:
• Loading originals
45
• Selecting print media
49
• Loading paper in the tray
50
• Printing on special media
55
• Setting the paper size and type
59
• Selecting an output location
61
Loading originals
You can use the scanner glass or the dual scan document feeder (DSDF) to load
an original for copying, scanning, and sending a fax.
1
Open the DSDF.
1
On the scanner glass
Using the scanner glass, you can copy or scan originals. You can get the best
scan quality, especially for colored or gray-scaled images. Make sure that no
originals are in the document feeder. If an original is detected in the document
feeder, the machine gives it priority over the original on the scanner glass.
Preparing originals
•
Do not load paper larger than 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches).
•
Make sure any glue, ink, or correction fluid on the paper is completely dry
before loading.
2. Media and Tray
45
Loading originals
2
Place the original face down on the scanner glass and align it with the
registration guide at the top left corner of the glass.
• Leaving the DSDF open while copying may affect copy quality and toner
consumption.
• Dust on the scanner glass may cause black spots on the printout. Always
keep it clean.
• If you are copying a page from a book or magazine, lift the DSDF until its
hinges are caught by the stopper, and then close the lid. If the book or
magazine is thicker than 30 mm (1 inch), start copying with the lid open.
• Be careful not to break the scanner glass. You may get hurt.
• Do not put hands on the scanner glass while closing the DSDF. The DSDF
may fall on your hands and cause injury.
• Do not look at the light inside of the scanner while copying or scanning.
It is harmful to eyes.
3
Close the DSDF.
2. Media and Tray
46
Loading originals
2
In the dual scan document feeder (DSDF)
1
Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before
loading originals.
2
Load the originals face up into the DSDF. Make sure that the bottom of
the original stack matches the paper size marked on the document input
tray.
Preparing originals
•
•
Do not load paper smaller than 105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.8 inches) or larger
than 216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches).
Do not attempt to load the following types of paper, in order to prevent
paper jam, low print quality, and machine damage.
-
Carbon-paper or carbon-backed paper
-
Coated paper
-
Onion skin or thin paper
-
Wrinkled or creased paper
-
Curled or rolled paper
-
Torn paper
•
Remove all staples and paper clips before loading.
•
Make sure any glue, ink, or correction fluid on the paper is completely dry
before loading.
•
Do not load originals that include different sizes or weights of paper.
•
Do not load booklets, pamphlets, transparencies, or documents with other
unusual characteristics.
Using the document feeder, you can load up to 50 sheets of paper (75 g/m2,
20 lb bond) for one job.
2. Media and Tray
47
Loading originals
3
Adjust the document width guides to the paper size.
Dust on the DSDF glass may cause black lines on the printout. Always keep
the glass clean.
2. Media and Tray
48
Selecting print media
You can print on a variety of print media, such as plain paper, envelopes, labels,
and transparencies. Always use print media that meet the guidelines for use
with your machine.
• Some print media may meet all of the guidelines in this user’s guide and
still not produce satisfactory results. This may be the result of the sheets
characteristics, improper handling, unacceptable temperature and
humidity levels, or other variables over which cannot be controlled.
3
Guidelines for select the print media
Print media that does not meet the guidelines outlined in this user’s guide may
cause the following problems:
•
Poor print quality
•
Increased paper jams
•
Premature wear on the machine.
Properties, such as weight, composition, grain, and moisture content, are
important factors that affect the machine’s performance and the output quality.
When you choose print materials, consider the following:
•
The type, size, and weight of the print media for your machine are described
in print media specifications (see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
•
Desired outcome: The print media you choose should be appropriate for
your project.
•
Brightness: Some print media are whiter than others and produce sharper,
more vibrant images.
•
Surface smoothness: The smoothness of the print media affects how crisp
the printing looks on the paper.
• Before purchasing large quantities of print media, ensure that it meets
the requirements specified in this user’s guide.
• Using print media that does not meet these specifications may cause
problems or require repairs. Such repairs are not covered by Samsung’s
warranty or service agreements.
• The amount of paper put into the tray may differ according to media
type used (see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
• Make sure not to use the inkjet photo paper with this machine. It could
cause damage to the machine.
• Using flammable print media can cause a fire.
• Use designated print media (see "Print media specifications" on page
249).
The use of flammable media or foreign materials left in the printer may lead
to overheating of the unit and, in rare cases may cause a fire.
The amount of paper put into the tray may differ according to media type used
(see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
2. Media and Tray
49
Loading paper in the tray
4
Tray 1 / optional tray
2
Squeeze the paper width guide, and pull it to the end of the tray.
Load the print media you use for the majority of your print jobs into the standard
tray. The standard tray can hold a maximum of 550 sheets of plain paper (75 g/
m2, 20 lb bond).
You can purchase an optional tray (see "Available accessories" on page 235).
Using photographic paper or coated paper may cause problems, that
require repairs. Such repairs are not covered by the warranty or service
agreements.
1 Paper width guide
1
Pull out the tray.
3
Squeeze the paper length guide, and pull it to the end of the tray.
1 Paper length guide
2. Media and Tray
50
Loading paper in the tray
4
Flex and fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before
loading papers.
5
Load the paper.
6
After inserting paper into the tray, squeeze the paper width guides and
slide them to the desired paper size marked at the bottom of the tray.
• Do not push the paper width guide too far causing the media to warp.
• If you do not adjust the paper width guide, it may cause paper jams.
• Do not use a paper with a leading-edge curl, it may cause a paper jam or
the paper can be wrinkled.
2. Media and Tray
51
Loading paper in the tray
• Do not overload the tray. Otherwise, it may cause paper jams. Make sure
that the paper is below the maximum paper capacity guide inside
thetray.
7
Insert the tray back into the machine.
When you print a document, set the paper type and size for the tray.
•
See "Setting the paper size and type" on page 59.
If you experience problems with paper feeding, check whether the paper
meets the media specification (see "Print media specifications" on page
249), and then try placing one sheet at a time in the multi-purpose tray (see
"Printing on special media" on page 55).
5
Multi-purpose tray
The multi-purpose tray can hold special sizes and types of print material, such as
postcards, note cards, and envelopes.
• Paper quantity indicator shows the amount of paper in the tray.
Tips on using the multi-purpose tray
1 Full
2 Empty
•
Load only one type, size, and weight of print media at a time in the multipurpose tray.
•
To prevent paper jams, do not add paper while printing when there is still
paper in the multi-purpose tray. This also applies to other types of print
media.
•
Print media should be loaded face up with the top edge going into the
multi-purpose tray first and be placed in the center of the tray.
2. Media and Tray
52
Loading paper in the tray
•
Always load only the specified print media to avoid paper jams and print
quality problems (see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
•
Flatten any curl on postcards, envelopes, and labels before loading them
into the multi-purpose tray.
1
2
3
Load the paper.
4
Squeeze the multi-purpose tray paper width guides and adjust them to
the width of the paper. Do not force too much, otherwise the paper will
bend resulting in a paper jam or skew.
Open the multi-purpose tray and open the extension if necessary.
Flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to separate the pages before
loading originals.
2. Media and Tray
53
Loading paper in the tray
5
When you print a document, set the paper type and size for the multipurpose tray.
•
See "Setting the paper size and type" on page 59.
2. Media and Tray
54
Printing on special media
The table below shows the available special media for each tray.
Types
Tray 1
Optional tray
Multi-purpose tray
Color
●
●
●
Preprinted
●
●
●
Recycled
●
●
●
Envelope
●
●
●
Or, you can set it from the control panel.
Labels
●
●
●
Then, set the paper type from the Printing preferences window > Paper tab >
Paper Type (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
CardStock
●
●
●
Bond
●
●
●
Archive
●
●
●
LetterHead
●
●
●
Punched
●
●
●
The paper setting in the machine and driver should match to print without a
paper mismatch error.
To change the paper setting set in the machine, from SyncThru™ Web Service
click Settings tab > Machine Settings > System > Input Tray (see "Settings
tab" on page 162).
For example, if you want to print on labels, select Labels for Paper Type.
When using special media, we recommend you feed a piece of paper at a
time. Check the maximum input number of media for each tray (see "Print
media specifications" on page 249).
(●: Supported, Blank: Not supported)
Types
Tray 1
Optional tray
Multi-purpose tray
Plain
●
●
●
Thick
●
●
●
The media types are shown in the Printing Preferences. This paper type
option allows you to set the type of paper to be loaded in the tray. This
setting appears in the list so that you can select it. This will let you get the
best quality printout. If not, the desired print quality may not be achieved.
●
Thicker
Thin
●
●
●
Cotton
●
●
●
2. Media and Tray
55
Printing on special media
6
Envelope
Successful printing on envelopes depends upon the quality of the envelopes.
To print an envelope, place it flap side down with the stamp area on the top left
side.
•
Do not use stamped envelopes.
•
Do not use envelopes with clasps, snaps, windows, coated lining, selfadhesive seals, or other synthetic materials.
•
Do not use damaged or poorly made envelopes.
•
Be sure the seam at both ends of the envelope extends all the way to the
corner of the envelope.
1 Acceptable
2 Unacceptable
•
•
When selecting envelopes, consider the following factors:
-
Weight: The weight of the envelope paper should not exceed 90 g/m2
(16 lb) otherwise, a jam may occur.
-
Construction: Prior to printing, envelopes should lie flat with less than
6 mm (0.25 inches) curl, and should not contain air.
-
Condition: Envelopes should not be wrinkled, nicked, or damaged.
-
Temperature: Use envelopes that are compatible with the heat and
pressure of the machine during operation.
•
Envelopes with a peel-off adhesive strip or with more than one flap that
folds over to seal must use adhesives compatible with the machine’s fusing
temperature about 170°C (338 °F) for 0.1 second. The extra flaps and strips
might cause wrinkling, creasing, or jams, and may even damage the fuser.
•
For the best print quality, position margins no closer than 15 mm (0.6
inches) from the edges of the envelope.
•
Avoid printing over the area where the envelope’s seams meet.
Use only well-constructed envelopes with sharp-and well-creased folds.
2. Media and Tray
56
Printing on special media
-
7
Labels
•
Make sure that there is no exposed adhesive material between labels.
Exposed areas can cause labels to peel off during printing, which can cause
paper jams. Exposed adhesive can also cause damage to machine
components.
•
Do not run a sheet of labels through the machine more than once. The
adhesive backing is designed for only a single pass through the machine.
•
Do not use labels that are separating from the backing sheet or are wrinkled,
bubbled, or damaged.
•
Do not load paper that does not have space between labels running the
same direction as the paper is being fed. Otherwise, it could cause paper
jams.
Load the paper with the side to be printed on facing down.
To avoid damaging the machine, use only labels designed for use in laser
machines.
•
Condition: Do not use labels with wrinkles, bubbles, or other
indications of separation.
When selecting labels, consider the following factors:
-
Adhesives: The adhesive material should be stable at your machine’s
fusing temperature about 170°C (338 °F) for 0.1 second.
-
Arrangement: Only use labels with no exposed backing between them.
Labels can peel off sheets that have spaces between the labels, causing
serious jams.
-
Curl: Prior to printing, labels must lie flat with no more than 13 mm (0.5
inches) of curl in any direction.
2. Media and Tray
57
Printing on special media
8
9
Card stock/ Custom-sized paper
Preprinted paper
When loading preprinted paper, the printed side should be facing up with an
uncurled edge at the front. If you experience problems with paper feeding, turn
the paper around. Note that print quality is not guaranteed.
•
Do not print on media smaller than 98 mm (3.8 inches) wide or 148 mm (5.8
inches) long.
•
In the software application, set margins to at least 6.4 mm (0.25 inches) away
from the edges of the material.
•
Must be printed with heat-resistant ink that will not melt, vaporize, or
release hazardous emissions when subjected to the machine’s fusing
temperature for 0.1 second (about 170°C (338°F)).
•
Preprinted paper ink must be non-flammable and should not adversely
affect machine rollers.
•
Before you load preprinted paper, verify that the ink used is compatible with
Laser printers.
2. Media and Tray
58
Setting the paper size and type
The paper setting in the machine and driver should match to print without a
paper mismatch error.
To change the paper setting set in the machine, from SyncThru™ Web Service
click Settings tab > Machine Settings > System > Input Tray (see "Settings
tab" on page 162).
10
Tray Settings
To change detailed tray settings, tap Settings > Tray Settings and select the
tray and options you want on the display screen.
Or, you can set it from the control panel.
Then, set the paper type from the Printing preferences window > Paper tab >
Paper Type (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
After loading paper in the paper tray, set the paper size and type using the
display screen.
•
Tray 1, MP Tray : You can set the Paper Size and Paper Type.
•
Tray 2 : You can set the Paper Size and Paper Type.
•
Paper Size: Allows you to change the paper size.
-
You can change the paper list on the display screen. The paper lists are
divided into the available A/B type and letter type paper in this machine.
2. Media and Tray
59
Setting the paper size and type
-
•
If there is no required size paper or you need to use custom sized paper,
tap the cardinal point arrows to set the paper size. You can also set and
save the custom size using Custom Size. You can select the custom size
whenever you need it.
•
Tray Confirmation Message: When you load paper into a tray, you can set
the confirmation message to appear automatically. This machine can detect
some paper sizes and types automatically. If you want to set the paper size
and type, or the machine cannot detect them, you can set the size and type
directly in the confirmation window.
•
Tray Protection: If you set tray 1 to On, for example, then tray 1 is excluded
during tray switching.
Paper Type: Allows you to change the paper type.
Options
This setting works for copy or print jobs: It doesn't affect fax jobs.
Scroll through the options by swiping up and down.
•
Auto Tray Switch: Determine whether or not the machine continues
printing when it detects the paper does not match. For example, if both tray
1 and tray 2 are filled with the same size paper, the machine automatically
prints from tray 2 after the tray 1 runs out of paper.
•
Auto Continue: This option allows you to continue printing when the paper
size you have set is mismatched with the paper in the tray. When this option
is activated, the machine continues printing using similar or large size paper.
If this option is inactivated, the machine waits until the required size paper
is loaded in the tray.
•
Paper Substitution: When the requested paper for a print job is not
available in the tray, this feature allows you to substitute similar paper size,
For example, if the requested letter sized paper is not available in the tray,
this machine substitutes A4 for the requested paper.
•
Tray Priority Settings: You can set the tray priority. If first setting is tray 1,
the machine automatically prints from tray 1 after the second setting tray
runs out of paper.
When the paper is substituted, some image loss may occur.
2. Media and Tray
60
Selecting an output location
The surface of the center tray may become hot if you print a large number
of pages at once. Make sure that you do not touch the surface, and do not
allow children near it.
The machine sends output to the output tray by default. The printed pages stack
on the output support, and the output support will help the printed pages to
align. Open the output support.
If paper coming out of the output try has problems, such as excessive curl,
try printing to the rear cover. The rear cover can only hold one piece of
paper at a time, do not let the papers stack on the rear cover.
2. Media and Tray
61
3. Printing
This chapter explains common printing tasks.
This chapter includes:
• Printer driver features
63
• Basic printing
64
• Opening printing preferences
66
• Using special print features
74
• Using direct printing utility
82
• Changing the default print settings
84
• Setting your machine as a default machine
85
• Printing to a file (PRN)
86
• Mac printing
87
• Linux printing
89
• Unix printing
91
Printer driver features
PCL/PSa b/
• The procedures in this chapter are mainly based on Windows 7.
• Check the operating systems that are compatible with your machine (see
"System requirements" on page 253).
Your printer drivers support the following standard features:
•
Paper orientation, size, source, and media type selection
•
Number of copies
You can also use various special printing features. The following table shows a
general overview of features supported by your printer drivers:
Feature
XPS
PSb
bc
Windows
Mac
Linux
Unix
Fit to page printing
●
●
Reduce and enlarge
printing
●
●
Different source for
first page
●
●
Cover page options
●
●
●
●
Raster compression
●
●
●
●
●
(PCL only)
Some models or operating system may not support the certain feature(s) in
the following table.
●
●
Watermark
●
●
Overlay
●
(PCL only)
PCL/PSa b/
Feature
Output options
PS
XPSbc
b
Windows
Mac
Linux
Unix
Machine quality
option
●
●
●
●
Poster printing
●
●
Multiple pages per
sheet
●
●
Booklet printing
●
●
●
Double-sided
printing (duplex)
●
●
a. The PostScript driver is recommended for best print image quality from PostScript-based
applications such as Acrobat Reader®, Adobe Illustrator®, Adobe Photoshop®, etc.
b. Download the software from the Samsung website and install it: (http://www.samsung.com
> find your product > Support or Downloads). Before installing, check whether your
computer’s OS support the software.
c. XPS printer driver can be installed only on Windows Vista OS or higher.
(●: Supported, Blank: Not supported)
3. Printing
63
Basic printing
• Mac printing (see "Mac printing" on page 87).
3
Select your machine from the Select Printer list.
• Linux printing (see "Linux printing" on page 89).
• UNIX printing (see "Unix printing" on page 91).
The following Printing Preferences window is for Notepad in Windows 7. Your
Printing Preferences window may differ, depending on your operating system
or the application you are using.
1
2
Open the document you want to print.
Select Print from the File menu.
The basic print settings including the number of copies and print range
are selected within the Print window.
To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer driver,
click Properties or Preferences in the application’s Print window to
change the print setting (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
4
To start the print job, click OK or Print in the Print window.
3. Printing
64
Basic printing
1
Canceling a print job
If the print job is waiting in the print queue or print spooler, cancel the job as
follows:
•
You can access this window by simply double-clicking the machine icon (
in the Windows task bar.
•
You can cancel the print job with the Cancel Print from the computers’
Samsung Printer Status program window (see "Using Samsung Printer
Status" on page 173).
)
3. Printing
65
Opening printing preferences
When you select an option in Printing Preferences, you may see a warning
mark,
, or
. An exclamation mark (
The screenshot may differ depending on model.
) means you can select that
certain option but it is not recommended, and ( ) mark means you cannot
select that option due to the machine’s setting or environment.
1
2
3
4
Open the document you want to print.
Select Print from the File menu.
Select your printer driver from the Select Printer list.
Click Properties or Preferences.
• You can apply Eco features to save paper and toner before printing (see
"Easy Eco Driver" on page 168).
• You can check the machine’s current status pressing the Printer Status
button (see "Using Samsung Printer Status" on page 173).
3. Printing
66
Opening printing preferences
2
3
Favorites tab
Listed items help you choose pre-defined settings.
The screenshot may differ depending on model.
Basic tab
Basic tab to set various printing options.
Orientation
This option allows you to select the direction in which information is printed on
a page.
Layout Options
This option allows you to select various ways to layout your document.
•
Single Page Per Side: This option is a basic layout option. This option allows
you to print a page on one side of a paper.
•
Multiple Pages Per Side: See "Printing multiple pages on one sheet of
paper" on page 74.
•
Poster Printing: See "Printing posters" on page 74.
•
Booklet Printing: See "Printing booklets" on page 75.
•
Page Border: This option allows you to print your document on which
border line is. This option is not available for Poster Printing and Booklet
Printing.
3. Printing
67
Opening printing preferences
Double-Sided Printing
Paper Options
This option allows you to print on both sides of paper (see "Printing on both
sides of the paper" on page 76).
•
Original Size: This option allows you to set the actual paper size of the
originals.
•
Output Size: This option allows you to scale your print job to any selected
paper size regardless of the originals size (see "Fitting your document to a
selected paper size" on page 77).
4
Paper tab
Use the Paper tab options to set the basic paper handling specifications.
Copies
This option allows you to choose the number of copies to be printed. You can
select 1 to 9999 copies.
Percentage: This option allows you to change the size of a page’s
contents to appear larger or smaller on the printed page by typing in a
percentage you want (see "Change the size by percentage of your
document" on page 77).
•
Source: Make sure that Source is set to the corresponding paper tray. Use
MP Tray when printing on special materials, such as envelopes and
transparencies.
•
Type: This option allows you to set the type of paper to be loaded in the tray.
This will let you get the best quality printout. If not, the desired print quality
may not be achieved.
•
Specical Page: This option is allows you to make special pages such as
covers. You can add, delete or update the special page settings to the list.
This option is available only when you use the PCL printer driver.
3. Printing
68
Opening printing preferences
Toner Save
5
Graphics tab
Use the Graphic tab options to adjust the print quality for your specific printing
needs.
The Toner Save setting allows the user to save printing toner when printing a
draft version of a document. Select Off to print in normal mode and select On to
print with less toner applied to the page.
6
Quality
Advanced tab
The higher the setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and graphics.
The higher setting also may increase the time it takes to print a document.
Use the Advanced tab to set various printing options.
Font/Text
Watermark
Select Clear Text to print text darker than on a normal document.
See "Using watermarks" on page 78.
Check All Text Black to print in solid black, regardless of the color it appears on
the screen.
Overlay
Graphic Controller
See "Using overlay" on page 80.
It allows user to emphasize edges of texts and fine lines for improving
readability and align each color channel registration in color printing mode.
3. Printing
69
Opening printing preferences
Output options
Job Accounting
•
This option allows you to print with the given permission.
Print Order: This options allows you to set the sequence in which the pages
will print. Print Odd Pages and Print Even Pages are available only when you
use the PCL printer driver.
•
Skip Blank Pages: This option allows you to specify not to print blank pages
in the original data.
•
Manual Margin: This option allows you to specify binding margin. Binding
margin adjusts binding position. This option is not available when you use the
PS printer driver.
If you click Reset, settings in the Advanced option returns to the default
setting.
•
User permission: If you check this option, only users with user permission
can start a print job.
•
Group permission: If you check this option, only groups with group
permission can start a print job.
• Click the question mark(
) from the upper-right corner of the window
and click on any option you want to know about.
• Administrators can enable job accounting and configure permissions in
the control panel or SyncThru™ Web Service. For the detailed
information about them, refer to the Administrator’s Guide.
Security
Encrypts printing data first, and transmits it to the machine. This feature protects
the printing information to prevent your data from being comprised on your
network. Job Encryption feature is enabled only when the hard drive is
installed. The hard drive is used to decrypt the printing data.
3. Printing
70
Opening printing preferences
Result Simulator
7
Eco tab
The Eco tab allows you to save print resources and lead you to eco-friendly
printing. When you select Eco Printing, you can see the eco image (
)on
some options. Also, Some options are not available to use in the eco mode.
Eco Options
•
Printer Default: If you select this option, this feature is determined by the
setting you’ve made on the control panel of the machine.
•
None: Disables this option.
•
Eco Printing: Eco mode gets activated. Select Double-Sided Printing,
Layout, and Skip Blank Pages you want to use in eco mode. As long as you
do not change the options from the other tabs, the document will be
printed out as set in the eco mode.
•
Result Simulator shows the result of reduced emission of carbon dioxide, used
electricity, and the amount of saved paper in accordance with the settings you
selected.
• The results are calculated on the basis that the total number of printed
paper is one hundred without a blank page when the eco mode is
disabled.
• Referred to the calculation coefficient about CO2, energy and paper from
IEA(International Energy Agency), the index of Ministry of Internal Affairs
and Communication of Japan and www.remanufacturing.org.uk. Each
model has a different index.
• The power consumption in printing mode refers to the average printing
power consumption in this machine.
• The actual saved or reduced amount may differ depending on the
operating system used, computing performance, application software,
connection method, media type, media size, job complexity, etc.
Passcode: If the administrator sets On-Forced in Default Eco Mode for this
machine, the eco mode is always set by this machine’s eco setting, while the
Eco Options in the printer driver are disabled. If you need to change the
print settings, click Passcode and enter the password or contact your
administrator.
3. Printing
71
Opening printing preferences
8
•
Spool: This option can be useful when handling large amounts of data. If
you select this setting, the printer spools the document into the mass
storage device and then prints it from the mass storage device queue,
decreasing the computer’s work load.
•
Print Schedule: Select this setting to print the document at a specified time.
Samsung tab
Use the Samsung tab to display the copyright and the version number of the
driver. If your computer is connected to the Internet, you can have access to
services.
• Job Name: This option is used when you need to find a stored file using
the control panel.
9
Print Mode
This option allows you to choose how to print or save the printing file by using
the HDD in your machine. The default Print Mode is Normal which is for
printing without storing the printing file on the HDD. You can also use this
option in other tabs.
•
Normal: This mode prints without storing your document in the optional
memory.
•
Proof: This mode is useful when you print more than one copy. You can
print one copy first to check, then print the rest of the copies later.
•
Confidential: This mode is used for printing confidential documents. You
need to enter a password to print.
•
Store: Select this setting to save a document in the mass storage device
without printing.
•
Store and Print: This mode is used when printing and storing document at
the same time.
• User ID: This option is used when you need to find a stored file using the
control panel. The user name automatically appears as the user name
that you use to log on Windows.
• Enter Password: If the Property of the stored documents you selected
is Secured, you have to enter the password for the stored document.
This option is used for loading a stored file using the control panel.
• Confirm Password: Re-enter the password to confirm it.
3. Printing
72
Opening printing preferences
10
Using a favorite setting
To use a saved setting, select it in the Favorites tab. The machine is now set
to print according to the settings you have selected.To delete saved
settings, select it in the Favorites tab and click Delete.
The Favorites option, which is visible on each preferences tab except for the
Favorites tab and Samsung tab, allows you to save the current preferences for
future use.
11
To save a Favorites item, follow these steps:
1
2
Change the settings as needed on each tab.
3
4
5
Click Save.
Enter a name for the item in the Favorites input box.
Using help
Click the option you want to know on the Printing Preferences window and
press F1 on your keyboard.
Enter name and description, and then select the desired icon.
Click OK. When you save Favorites, all current driver settings are saved.
3. Printing
73
Using special print features
Special print features include:
•
"Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper" on page 74.
•
"Printing posters" on page 74.
•
"Printing booklets" on page 75.
•
"Printing on both sides of the paper" on page 76.
•
"Change the size by percentage of your document" on page 77.
•
"Fitting your document to a selected paper size" on page 77.
•
"Using watermarks" on page 78.
•
"Using overlay" on page 80.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
Click the Basic tab, select Multiple Pages per Side in the Type dropdown list.
3
4
Select Page Border to print a border around each page on the sheet.
5
6
7
12
Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper
Select the number of pages you want to print per sheet (2, 4, 6, 9, or 16)
in the Pages per Side drop-down list.
Select the page order from the Page Order drop-down list, if necessary.
Click the Paper tab, select the Original size, Source, and Type.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
13
You can select the number of pages to print on a single sheet of paper. To print
more than one page per sheet, the pages will be reduced in size and arranged in
the order you specify. You can print up to 16 pages on one sheet.
Printing posters
This feature allows you to print a single-page document onto 4, 9, or 16 sheets
of paper, for the purpose of pasting the sheets together to form one poster-size
document.
3. Printing
74
Using special print features
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
3
4
Click the Basic tab, select Poster Printing in the Type drop-down list.
5
6
7
Select the page layout you want.
14
Printing booklets
This feature prints your document on both sides of a paper and arranges the
pages so that the paper can be folded in half after printing to produce a booklet.
Select the Poster Overlap value. Specify Poster Overlap in millimeters
or inches by selecting the radio button on the upper right of Basic tab to
make it easier to paste the sheets together.
Click the Paper tab, select the Original size, Source, and Type.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
You can complete the poster by pasting the sheets together.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access the
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
Click the Basic tab, select Booklet Printing from the Type drop-down
list.
3
4
Click the Advanced button. Then select the option you want.
Click the Paper tab, select the Original size, Source, and Type.
The Booklet Printing option is not available for all paper sizes. In order to
find out the available paper size for this feature, select the available paper
size in the Original size option on the Paper tab.
If you select an unavailable paper size, this option can be automatically
canceled. Select only available paper. (paper without
or mark).
5
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
3. Printing
75
Using special print features
15
•
Long Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in
bookbinding.
•
Short Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in calendars.
•
Reverse Double-Sided Printing: Check this option to reverse the
print order when duplex printing.
Printing on both sides of the paper
You can print on both sides of a paper; duplex. Before printing, decide how you
want your document oriented.
Do not print on both sides of the special media, such as labels, envelopes, or
thick paper to print on both sides of paper. It may cause a paper jam or
damage the machine.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
3
Click the Basic tab.
From the Double-Sided Printing section, select the binding option you
want.
•
Printer Default: If you select this option, this feature is determined
by the setting you’ve made on the control panel of the machine. This
option is available only when you use the PCL printer driver.
•
None: Disables this feature.
4
5
Click the Paper tab, select the Original size, Source, and Type.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
3. Printing
76
Using special print features
16
17
Change the size by percentage of your document
You can change the size of a document to appear larger or smaller on the
printed page by typing in a percentage you want.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
3
4
Click the Paper tab.
This printer feature allows you to scale your print job to any selected paper size
regardless of the document size. This option can be useful when you want to
check fine details on a small document.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
3
4
5
6
Click the Paper tab.
Select actual paper size of the originals from the Original Size.
Enter the scaling rate in the Percentage input box.
You can also click the up/down arrows to select the scaling rate.
You cannot use this feature when you select a size of paper from the Output
Size.
5
6
Fitting your document to a selected paper size
Select the Source and Type.
Select actual paper size of the originals from the Original Size.
Select the size of paper to be printed in the tray from the Output Size.
Select the Source and Type.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
3. Printing
77
Using special print features
Using an existing watermark
18
Using watermarks
The watermark option allows you to print text over an existing document. For
example, you use it when you want to have large gray letters reading “DRAFT”
or “CONFIDENTIAL” printed diagonally across the first page or all pages of a
document.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
Click the Advanced tab, and select the desired watermark from the
Watermark drop-down list.
• Watermark Message: Allows users to enter the watermark which is the
user want to print.
• Image file: Allows users to load the watermark image which is the user
want to print.
• Watermark name: Allows users to enter the watermark name for adding
to watermark drop-down list.
There are several predefined watermarks that come with the machine. They can
be modified, or you can add new ones to the list.
• First Page Only: Prints watermark only on the first page. Not checked by
default.
• Header: You can add the selected text to the Top left, Top center, or Top
right.
• Footer: You can add the selected text to the Bottom left, Bottom center,
or Bottom right.
3
Click OK or Print until you exit the print window.
Creating a watermark
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
From the Advanced tab, select Edit... from the Watermark drop-down
list.
3. Printing
78
Using special print features
3
Enter a text message in the Watermark Message box. You can enter up
to 256 characters.
When the First Page Only box is checked, the watermark prints on the
first page only.
4
5
6
Select watermark options.
4
5
Click Update to save the changes.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
Deleting a watermark
You can select the font name, style, size, and shade from the Font
Attributes section, as well as set the angle of the watermark from the
Watermark Alignment and Angle section.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
Click Add to add a new watermark to the Current Watermarks list.
2
Click the Advanced tab, select Edit... from the Watermark drop-down
list.
When you finish editing, click OK or Print until you exit the Print
window.
3
Select the watermark you want to delete from the Current Watermarks
list and click Delete.
4
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
To stop printing the watermark, select None from the Watermark drop-down
list.
Editing a watermark
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
2
Click the Advanced tab, select Edit... from the Watermark drop-down
list.
3
Select the watermark you want to edit from the Current Watermarks list
and change the watermark message and options.
3. Printing
79
Using special print features
19
Using overlay
This option is available only when you use the PCL printer driver.
What is an overlay?
An overlay is text and/or images stored on the computer hard drive (HDD) as a
special file format that can be printed on any document. Overlays are often used
to take the place of letterhead paper. Rather than using preprinted letterhead,
you can create an overlay containing exactly the same information that is
currently on your letterhead. To print a letter with your company’s letterhead,
you do not need to load preprinted letterhead paper in the machine just print
the letterhead overlay on your document.
1
Create or open a document containing text or an image for use in a new
page overlay. Position the items exactly as you wish them to appear
when printed as an overlay.
2
To save the document as an overlay, access Printing Preferences (see
"Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
3
Click the Advanced tab, and select Create from the Overlay drop-down
list.
4
In the Save As window, type a name up to eight characters in the File
name box. Select the destination path, if necessary (The default is
C:\Formover).
5
6
Click Save.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
When a confirming message window appears, click Yes.
7
Creating a new page overlay
The file is not printed. Instead, it is stored on your computer hard disk
drive.
The overlay document size must be the same as the document you print
with the overlay. Do not create an overlay with a watermark.
To use a page overlay, you must create a new page overlay containing your logo
or image.
3. Printing
80
Using special print features
Using a page overlay
7
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
The selected overlay prints on your document.
After an overlay has been created, it is ready to be printed with your document.
To print an overlay with a document:
1
2
3
4
5
Create or open the document you want to print.
To change the print settings from your software application, access
Printing Preferences (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
Deleting a page overlay
Click the Advanced tab.
You can delete page overlays that you no longer use.
Select the Print Overlay from the Overlay drop-down list.
If the overlay file you want does not appear in the Overlay File 1 or
Overlay File 2 drop-down list, select Load from the Overlay List. Select
the overlay file you want to use.
If you have stored the overlay file you want to use in an external source,
you can also load the file when you access the Load window.
After you select the file, click Open. The file appears in the Overlay List
box and is available for printing. Select the overlay from the Overlay List
box.
6
The resolution of the overlay document must be the same as that of the
document you will print with the overlay.
If necessary, check Confirm Page Overlay When Printing box. If this
box is checked, a message window appears each time you submit a
document for printing, asking you to confirm your wish to print an
overlay on your document.
1
2
3
In the Printing Preferences window, click the Advanced tab.
Select the Print Overlay from the Overlay drop-down list.
Select the overlay you want to delete from the Overlay List box.
If the overlay file you want does not appear in the Overlay List, select
Load from the Overlay List. Select the overlay file you want to delete.
4
5
6
Click Delete.
When a confirming message window appears, click Yes.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.
If this box is not checked and an overlay has been selected, the overlay
automatically prints with your document.
3. Printing
81
Using direct printing utility
This chapter explains how to use Direct Printing Utility to print PDF files without
open the files.
• You cannot print PDF files that are restricted. Deactivate the printing
restriction feature and retry printing.
• You cannot print PDF files that are restricted by a password. Deactivate
the password feature, and retry printing.
• Whether or not a PDF file can be printed using the Direct Printing Utility
program depends on how the PDF file was created.
21
Printing
There are several ways you can print using the Direct Printing Utility.
From the Direct Printing Utility window
1
• The Direct Printing Utility program supports PDF version 1.7 and below.
For higher versions, you must open the file to print it.
20
What is Direct Printing Utility?
Direct Printing Utility is a program that sends a PDF file directly to your machine
to print without having to open the file. It sends data through the Windows
spooler using the port of the printer driver. It only supports PDF format.
To install this program:
Download the software from the Samsung website then unpack and install it:
(http://www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or Downloads).
From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs.
•
For Windows 8, from Charms, select Search > Apps.
2
3
Find Samsung Printers > Direct Printing Utility.
4
Select the file you wish to print and click Open.
Select your machine from the Select Printer drop-down list and click
Browse.
The file is added in the Select Files section.
5
6
Customize the machine settings for your needs.
Click Print. The selected PDF file is sent to the machine.
3. Printing
82
Using direct printing utility
22
Using the right-click menu
1
Right-click on the PDF file you wish to print and select Direct Printing.
The Direct Printing Utility window appears with the PDF file is added.
2
3
4
Select the machine you wish to use.
Customize the machine settings for your needs.
Click Print. The selected PDF file is sent to the machine.
3. Printing
83
Changing the default print settings
Most Windows applications will override settings you specify in the printer
driver. Change all print settings available in the software application first,
and change any remaining settings using the printer driver.
1
Click the Windows Start menu.
•
2
3
4
5
6
Change the settings on each tab.
Click OK.
If you want to change the settings for each print job, change it in Printing
Preferences.
For Windows 8, from the Charms, select Search > Settings.
For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printer and Faxes.
•
For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware
and Sound > Printers.
•
For Windows 7/8, select Control Panel > Devices and Printers.
•
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >
Devices and Printers.
Right-click on your machine.
For Windows XP/Server 2003/Server 2008/Vista, select Printing
Preferences.
For Windows 7/8 or Windows Server 2008 R2, from context menus, select
Printing preferences.
If Printing preferences has a ►, you can select other printer drivers
connected to the selected printer.
3. Printing
84
Setting your machine as a default machine
1
Click the Windows Start menu.
•
2
3
4
For Windows 8, from the Charms, select Search > Settings.
For Windows XP/Server 2003, select Printer and Faxes.
•
For Windows Server 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware
and Sound > Printers.
•
For Windows 7/8, select Control Panel > Devices and Printers.
•
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >
Devices and Printers.
Select your machine.
Right-click your machine and select Set as Default Printer.
For Windows 7 or Windows Server 2008 R2, if Set as default printer has a
►, you can select other printer drivers connected to the selected printer.
3. Printing
85
Printing to a file (PRN)
You will sometimes need to save the print data as a file.
To create a file:
1
Check the Print to file box at the Print window.
2
3
Click Print.
If you type in only the file name, the file is automatically saved in My
Documents, Documents and Settings or Users. The saved folder may
differ, depending on your operating system or the application you are
using.
Type in the destination path and the file name, and then click OK.
For example c:\Temp\file name.
3. Printing
86
Mac printing
24
Changing printer settings
Some features may not be available depending on models or options. It
means that the features are not supported.
You can use advanced printing features when using your machine.
23
Printing a document
When you print with a Mac, you need to check the printer driver settings in each
application you use. Follow the steps below to print from a Mac:
Open an application and select Print from the File menu. The machine name,
which appears in the printer properties window, may differ depending on the
machine in use. Except for the name, the composition of the printer properties
window is similar to the following.
25
1
2
Open the document to print.
3
Choose your paper size, orientation, scaling, other options, and make
sure that your machine is selected. Click OK.
4
5
6
Open the File menu and click Print.
Open the File menu and click Page Setup (Document Setup in some
applications).
Printing multiple pages on one sheet
You can print more than one page on a single sheet of paper. This feature
provides a cost-effective way to print draft copies.
1
2
Open an application, and select Print from the File menu.
3
4
Select the other options to use.
Choose the number of copies and indicate which pages to print.
Click Print.
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation. In the Pages
per Sheet drop-down list, select the number of pages you want to print
on one sheet of paper.
Click Print.
The machine prints the selected number of pages to print on one sheet
of paper.
3. Printing
87
Mac printing
26
If you print more than 2 copies, the first copy and the second copy might
print on the same sheet of paper. Avoid printing on both sides of paper
when you are printing more than 1 copy.
Printing on both sides of the paper
Some features may not be available depending on models or options. It
means that the features are not supported (see "Variety feature" on page
10).
27
Using help
Before printing in the duplex mode, decide on which edge you will be binding
your finished document. The binding options are, as follows:
•
Long-Edge Binding: This option is the conventional layout used in book
binding.
•
Short-Edge Binding: This option is the type often used with calendars.
1
2
3
4
5
Click the question mark on the bottom-left corner of the window and click on
the topic you want to know about. A pop-up window appears with information
about that option's feature, which is provided from the driver.
From your Mac application, select Print from the File menu.
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation.
Select a binding orientation from the Two-Sided option.
Select the other options to use.
Click Print and the machine prints on both sides of the paper.
3. Printing
88
Linux printing
Some features may not be available depending on models or options. It
means that the features are not supported.
Automatic/manual duplex printing may not be available depending on
models. You can alternatively use the lpr printing system or other
applications for odd-even printing (see "Features by model" on page 8).
28
Printing from applications
29
Printing files
There are a lot of Linux applications that allow you to print using Common UNIX
Printing System (CUPS). You can print on your machine from any such
application.
1
2
You can print text, image, pdf files on your machine using the standardCUPS
directly from the command line interface. The CUPS lp or lpr utility allows you to
do that. You can print these files by using below command format.
Open the document to print.
"lp -d <printer name> -o <option> <file name>"
Open the File menu and click Page Setup (Print Setup for
someapplications).
Please refer to lp or lpr man page on your system for more details.
30
3
Choose your paper size, orientation, and makesure that your machine is
selected. Click Apply.
4
5
6
7
8
Open the File menu and click Print.
Configuring Printer Properties
You can change the default printing options or connection type with Printing
utility supplied by o/s.
Select your machine to print.
Choose the number of copies and indicate which pages to print.
1
Launch Printing utility(Go to System > Administration > Printing
menu or execute "system-config-printer" command in Terminal
program).
2
Select your printer and double-click it.
Change other printing options in each tab, if necessary.
Click Print.
3. Printing
89
Linux printing
3
4
Change default printing options or connection type.
Click Apply button.
3. Printing
90
Unix printing
Some features may not be available depending on models or options. It
means that the features are not supported (see "Features by model" on
page 8).
31
Proceeding the print job
After installing the printer, choose any of the image, text, or PS files to print.
1
Execute “printui <file_name_to_print>” command.
5
Press OK to start the print job.
32
Changing the machine settings
The UNIX printer driver Print Job Manager in which the user can select various
print options in printer Properties.
The following hot keys may also be used: “H” for Help, “O” for OK, “A” for Apply,
and “C” for Cancel.
General tab
For example, if you are printing “document1”
•
Paper Size: Set the paper size as A4, Letter, or other paper sizes, according
to your requirements.
This will open the UNIX Printer Driver Print Job Manager in which the
user can select various print options.
•
Paper Type: Choose the type of the paper. Options available in the list box
are Printer Default, Plain, and Thick.
Select a printer that has been already added.
•
Paper Source: Select from which tray the paper is used. By default, it is Auto
Selection.
•
Orientation: Select the direction in which information is printed on a page.
•
Duplex: Print on both sides of paper to save paper.
printui document1
2
3
4
Select the printing options from the window such as Page Selection.
Select how many copies are needed in Number of Copies.
To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer driver,
press Properties.
3. Printing
91
Unix printing
Printer-Specific Settings tab
Automatic/manual duplex printing may not be available depending on
models. You can alternatively use the lpr printing system or other
applications for odd-even printing.
•
Multiple pages: Print several pages on one side of the paper.
•
Page Border: Choose any of the border styles (e.g., Single-line hairline,
Double-line hairline)
Select various options in the JCL and General frames to customize various
settings. These options are specific to the printer and depend on the PPD file.
Image tab
In this tab, you can change the brightness, resolution, or image position of your
document.
Text tab
Set the character margin, line space, or the columns of the actual print output.
Margins tab
•
Use Margins: Set the margins for the document. By default, margins are not
enabled. The user can change the margin settings by changing the values in
the respective fields. Set by default, these values depend on the page size
selected.
•
Unit: Change the units to points, inches, or centimeters.
3. Printing
92
4. Copying
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for copying documents.
This chapter includes:
• Understanding the copy screen
94
• Basic copying
103
• Quick copying
104
• ID card copying
105
Understanding the copy screen
When you tap Copy from the home screen or Apps , the Copy screen appears.
This screen has several tabs and many copying options. All the options are
grouped by feature so you can configure your selections easily. If want to go
home, tap the home(
Virtual Hard Key
• The positon of virtual hard keys is fixed on the right side of screen.
) button.
• When an app is launched, the virtual hard keys are shown.
• If the screen is touched, the virtual hard keys always appear.
Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and then
• If the
,
touched, the virtual hard keys are hidden and shown.
click on any option you want to know about.
Button
Name
Description
1
Command keys
Button
Name
Reset
Reset the current machine’s configuration.
Interrupt
Suspend the current job, allowing for urgent copying.
Stop
Stop a job at any time. A popup window appears to
show the jobs that you can stop.
Start
Start a job.
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menus.
Search
Search for a desired menu or app.
My Program
Add an app to my program list.
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow)
,
Set the number of copies printed.
4. Copying
94
Understanding the copy screen
2
Button
Copy tab
Name
Description
Preview for
status
Shows the job preview.
Preview for
play
Scans for job.
Preview edit
mode
Preview edit mode appears when you tap the
play(
) button in the preview pane. Adjust the
prescanned image with operation functions such
as rotate and crop.
Some features are not available to
preview edit mode.
Start
Preview
Starts a job.
Changing Darkness
Display the originals type.
Button
Name
Setting
History
Description
View changed options list.
You can adjust the darkness level of a copy if needed for easier reading if the
original contains faint markings or dark images. Adjust the darkness level using
the control bar. This feature allows you to print dark images lighter, or light
images darker.
4. Copying
95
Understanding the copy screen
Tap Darkness (
•
Proof Copy: Allows you to print a test copy to check the quality and
alignment of the printout. Tap this option in the Action Overflow menu to
print a proof copy. After ensuring that the copy is perfect, tap the Start
button to print the rest of the copies.
•
ID Copy: Allows you to copy both sides of a two-sided original onto one
sheet of paper. This feature is helpful for copying originals with important
information on both sides, such as driver's licenses.
•
Save to Box: Allows you to save scanned originals to the hard disk drive in
the machine. You can then print these saved documents at a later date or
store them as printable files. Tap this option in the Action Overflow menu to
save a document to the hard disk drive in the machine.
•
Save as Default: Allows you to save the current copy options as the default
copy settings. After you save the default copy settings, all future copy tasks
use these settings. Tap this option in the Action Overflow menu to save the
current settings as the default settings.
•
Restore Default: Allows you to restore the copy settings to the default
settings of the machine. This option changes the current copy settings to
the original copy settings configured at the factory. Tap the Restore Default
option in this menu to restore the default settings.
•
Copy Settings: The Another Page Confirmation option specifies whether
the machine requires you to confirm that the scanning is complete after
each page. Select this option to efficiently copy multiple pages in a single
copy job.
) to show the slider control.
Selecting the type of originals
Use the original type setting to improve copy quality by selecting the
appropriate document type for a copy job.
•
Text : Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo : Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
•
Photo : Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
Sub menu (Action overflow)
•
Eco: When Eco mode is enabled, you can select only economical printing
settings. Tap the Eco option in the Action Overflow menu to turn Eco mode
on or off.
•
Add to My Program: Add an app to my program list.
•
Build Job: This option can be turned on or off. When this option is on:After
the scanning is finished, the Scan More window appears to ask if you want
to scan another page. If you select Yes, then you can scan another page in
the current job. If you select No, then the scanning process is completed and
the remainder of the job is performed.
4. Copying
96
Understanding the copy screen
• Another Page Confirmation: This option specifies whether the
machine requires you to confirm that the scanning is complete after each
page. Select this option to efficiently copy multiple pages in a single copy
job.
Setting options
The Copy tab provides two sections. The More tab provides additional sections.
• You can customize the UI of each tab using UI configuration option
•
UI Configuration: Allows you to select the options that appear in the Copy
menu. Tap the + or - symbol on the menu icons to add or remove menus.
You can also tap and hold a menu icon to move it to a different position or
tap Clear All to remove all the menus.
(Send >
Sub menu(action overflow) > UI Configuration).
• Some menus are disabled. If so, it is not available to your machine.
•
(Help) app explains the normal and usual procedure for copying
originals. Click the
Job progress
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick
menu) and then click on any option you want to know about.
This menu appears whenever the machine is processing a job.
•
Detail : Tap this button to see the status, type, and time of the job.
•
Preview Area : Allows you to see a preview of the document being copied.
The image in the preview area indicates the current send settings, such as
the orientation and size of the printout.
•
Send Feedback : Allows you to send feedback about the current send job.
If you want to receive sending job by email, you can set from My page app
(see "Understanding the My Page menu" on page 37).
Paper Source
The paper source option sets the tray for this print job. The machine prints the
scanned image on the paper in the selected tray. You can see icons that
represent paper sizes and the amount of paper remaining in each tray.
Duplex
You can set the machine to print copies on both sides of paper.
To use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Log-in"
on page 280).
4. Copying
97
Understanding the copy screen
You can select the Original and Output binding type, either type is Book or
Calendar.
•
1 Sided: For originals or output binding type that are printed on one side
only.
•
2 Sided, Book: For originals or output binding type that are printed on both
sides.
•
2 Sided, Calendar : For originals or output binding type that are printed on
both sides, but the back is rotated 180 degrees.
Reduce/Enlarge
Sets the machine to sort the copy job. For example, if you make 2 copies of a 3
page original, one complete 3 page document will print followed by a second
complete document.
•
Collated: Prints output in sets to match the sequence of originals.
•
Uncollated: Prints output sorted into stacks of individual pages.
The reduce/enlarge feature allows you print an image larger or smaller than the
original. Tap the icons on the screen to reduce a copy by 25 % to 99 %, or enlarge
a copy by 101 % to 400 %.
•
100% (Original): Prints the copy at the same size as the original.
•
Auto: Reduces or enlarges the copy based on the size of the output paper.
•
Custom: You can set custom percentage(between25 to 400%).
•
XY Custom: You can set XY custom values(between 25 to 400%).
Use this option to set the actual paper size of the originals.
•
Other preset values: Reduces or enlarges the copy to a preset value. The
icons on the right side of the column indicate the presets to use when
copying to a different paper size.
•
Mixed Size: If the original uses a combination of both Letter and Legal-size
paper, the machine can use the proper-sized paper for each sheet from
multiple trays. For example, if the original is 3 pages, two Letter and one
Legal, the machine prints in order on the correct paper size for each page.
•
Custom size: If you need to set a custom value for a special size of paper,
use the arrows to set the required size.
Finishing
Original Size
You can set the print output options.
4. Copying
98
Understanding the copy screen
Original Orientation
•
Orientation: You can select the direction in which information is copied on
a page.
Use this option to set the orientation of the original.
•
•
Upright Images: Use this setting for an original document loaded with the
top toward the back of the machine.
Sideways Images: Use this setting for an original document loaded into the
DSDF with the top of the document toward the left side of the machine, or
an original document placed on the scanner glass with the top of the
document toward the right side of the machine.
Original type
Use this setting to improve copy quality by selecting the appropriate document
type for the current job.
•
Text: Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo: Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
•
Photo: Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
Booklet
The machine automatically prints on one or both sides of the paper, which are
then folded to produce a booklet with all pages in the correct sequence. The
machine will also reduce and correctly adjust the position of each image to fit on
the selected paper.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
1 Sided Originals: Copy one side of the original to one sheet of a booklet.
•
2 Sided Originals, Book: Copy each side of an original to one sheet of a
booklet.
•
2 Sided Originals, Calendar: Copy each side of an original to one page of a
booklet. The second side of each original is rotated 180 degrees so the text
will be upright in the booklet.
Book Copy
N-up
Reduces the size of the original images and prints 2 -16 pages onto one sheet of
paper.
•
Off: Disable this feature.
•
N-Up: Copies the specified number of pages from the original onto one
sheet of paper.
Use this feature to copy a book. If the book is too thick, lift the DSDF until its
hinges are engaged by the stopper, then close the DSDF. If the book or
magazine is thicker than 30 mm (1.18 inches), start copying with the DSDF open.
4. Copying
99
Understanding the copy screen
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner
glass.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Left Page: Prints only the left page of the book.
•
Right Page: Prints only the right page of the book.
•
Both Pages(From Left): Prints both facing pages from the left page.
•
Both Pages(From Right): Prints both facing pages from a right page.
•
Book Center & Edge Erase: Erases shadows caused by bindings or book
edges from the center and side edges of copies.
•
Duplex: Erases shadows caused by bindings or book edges from the center
nd side edges of copies.
Poster Copy
This feature allows you to print a single-page document onto 4, 9, or 16 sheets
of paper, for the purpose of pasting the sheets together to form one poster-size
document.
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner
glass.
Image Repeat
This option prints several copies of the original image on the same side of a
single page. If you have other original in the DSDF, all other original images get
printed the same way.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Auto Repeat: The number of images is automatically determined by the
original image and paper size. The number of repeating images is
automatically selected based on size of the original, the size of output page,
and the reduce/enlarge percentage by up to 100 %.
•
Manual Repeat: Manually select the number of images from 2, 4, 6, 8, 9 or
16.
Watermark
The watermark option allows you to print text over an existing document. For
example, you use it when you want to have large gray letters reading “Draft” or
“Confidential” printed diagonally across the first page or all pages of a
document.
Stamp
You cannot apply stamps to booklets or posters.
4. Copying
100
Understanding the copy screen
Prints the IP Address, ID, Device Information, Comment, Page Number or
Date & Time on printouts. You can set the Text Size, Opacity or Position of the
stamp.
Overlay
An overlay is text and/or images stored on a computer hard drive (HDD) in a
special file format that can be printed on any document. Overlays can take the
place of traditional letterhead paper. Rather than using preprinted letterhead,
you can create an overlay matching the layout of the letterhead. To print a letter
on your company’s letterhead, you do not need to load preprinted letterhead in
the machine, just enable the letterhead overlay on your document.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
+ New: Create a new page overlay containing your logo or image.
•
Overlap: Select an overlap location.
Erase Edge
You can copy the original without any edges or margins.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Border Erase: Erase an equal amount of edges from all copies.
•
Hole Punch Erase: Erase hole-punch marks from the left edge of copies.
Image Shift
To prevent images from overlapping with punch holes, staples, and other marks,
you can move an image’s position.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Auto Center: Automatically position at the center of the paper.
•
Custom Shift: Adjust the margins of the paper as needed.
Covers
The machine automatically adds covers to your copied set using stock taken
from a different tray. Covers must be the same size and orientation as the main
body of the job.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Front: Print the document with a front cover.
•
Back: Print the document with a back cover.
•
Front & Back: Prints the document with a front and back cover.
•
Cover Sheet: Sets the option for double-sided copying.
•
Paper Source: Selects the default paper tray to use.
Image Adjustment
This option allows you to manually adjust the image Darkness, Sharpness,
Contrast and Negative Image.
4. Copying
101
Understanding the copy screen
Background Adjustment
This option allows you to compensate for originals that contain color in the
background, such as newspapers or catalogs. You can use the options in this
menu to make the copies easier to read.
•
Background Density: Allows you to adjust the density of the background
in the scanned image. This feature is useful when scanning originals that
have turned yellow from age or originals with a dark background.
•
Backside Image: Allows you to erase any text or images that show through
from the other side of the original. You can use this feature to ensure that
your scanned output is clearly legible.
Mirror Image
This option allows you to reverse the original document like a mirror.
4. Copying
102
Basic copying
This is the usual procedure to copy your original documents.
1
2
Tap Copy from the home screen or Apps.
3
4
Adjust the settings on the Copy tab and More tab.
5
Tap
copying.
Place the originals face up in the DSDF or place a single original face
down on the scanner glass and close the DSDF (see "Loading originals"
on page 45).
Enter the number of copies desired on the numeric keypad (or +, button) on the control panel, if necessary.
,
(Start ) from the control panel to begin
To cancel the current copy job, tap
(Stop)> tap Job Status on the
control panel. Then delete the job you want (see "Job Status" on page 34).
4. Copying
103
Quick copying
The Quick Copy menu allows you to quickly set common copy options without
having to open a lower level menu or another tab. However, this menu does not
offer every copy option available.
1
2
Tap Quick Copy from the home screen or Apps.
3
Adjust the settings (Paper Source, Reduce/Enlarge, Original
Orientation, Darkness, Duplex, N-UP, Collation).
4
Enter the number of copies desired on the numeric keypad (or +, button) on the control panel, if necessary.
5
Tap Start(
Place the originals face up in the DSDF or place a single original face
down on the scanner glass and close the DSDF (see "Loading originals"
on page 45).
) on the control panel to begin copying.
To cancel the current copy job, tap
(Stop)> tap Job Status on the
control panel. Then delete the job you want (see "Job Status" on page 34).
4. Copying
104
ID card copying
3
Place the front side of an original facing down on the scanner glass
where arrows indicate as shown. Then, close the scanner lid.
4
Tap
Your machine can print 2-sided originals on one sheet.
The machine prints one side of the original on the upper half of the paper and
the other side on the lower half without reducing the size of the original. This
feature is helpful for copying a small-sized item such as business card.
The original must be placed on the scanner glass to use this feature.
1
2
Tap ID Copy from the home screen or Apps.
If necessary, adjust the settings for each copy such as Print Layout,
Original Size, Paper Source, Adjust to Paper Size, and Align.
Follow the instructions on the control panel.
.
Your machine begins scanning the front side.
4. Copying
105
ID card copying
5
Turn the original over and place it on the scanner glass where arrows
indicate as shown. Then, close the scanner lid.
6
Tap
.
Your machine begins scanning the back side.
• If you do not press the
button, only the front side will be
copied.
• If the original is larger than the printable area, some portions may not be
printed.
4. Copying
106
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital files that can be stored on your computer.
This chapter includes:
• Understanding the Scan & Send screen
108
• Basic scan
116
• Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software
117
• Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
118
• Mac scanning
120
• Linux scanning
121
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
This section describes all scanning and fax functions. When you tap Scan & Send
from the home screen or Apps, the Scan & Send screen appears. This screen has
2 tabs and many options. All options are grouped by feature so that you can
configure the job easily. If want to go home, tap the home(
Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
) button.
(quick menu) and then
Command keys
Button
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menu.
Address book
Open your saved address book.
Fax
Send a fax.
My Program
Add an app to my program list.
click on any option you want to know about.
1
Send tab
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow)
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
108
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
Button
Name
+ Me
Description
When users are logged in, the destination
configured in their My Page profile appears.You
can set the destination in the Send to
Destination menu of the My Page app (see
"Understanding the My Page menu" on page 37).
Administrators can also set the default
destination in the sub menu (Action overflow) >
Send Settings > +Me Setting.
You must log in to use your + Me
destination. If you do not log in, then the
machine sends the copy to the + Me
destination specified by the
administrator.
Button
Name
Description
Reset
Reset to app default configuration.
On Hook
When you press this button, you can hear a dial tone.
Then enter a fax number. It is similar to making a call
using speaker phone.
Stop
Stop a job at any time. A popup window appears to
show the jobs that you can stop.
Start
Start a job.
Preview
Preview displays the original scanned image.
Virtual Hard Key
Button
Name
Description
Setting
History
View changed options list.
Preview for
status
Shows the job preview.
• The positon of virtual hard keys is fixed on the right side of screen.
• When an app is launched, the virtual hard keys are shown.
• If the screen is touched, the virtual hard keys always appear.
• If the
,
touched, the virtual hard keys are hidden and shown.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
109
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
Button
Name
Preview for
play
Description
Scans for job.
Selecting the color mode
Use one of the following options to use for the scan.
: This button appears to edit when
scanning. Adjust the prescanned image
with operation functions such as rotate
and crop.
•
Mono: Use black and white (1-bit per pixel).
•
Gray : Use grayscale (8-bit per pixel).
•
Color : Use color (24-bit per pixel, each of the RGB channels has 8 bits).
Selecting the original type
Start
Starts a job.
Use the original type setting to improve copy quality by selecting the
appropriate document type for a copy job.
•
Text : Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo : Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
You can adjust the brightness level of a copy if needed for easier reading if the
original contains faint markings or dark images. Adjust the brightness level
using the slider. This feature allows you to print dark images lighter, or light
images darker.
•
Photo : Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
Tap Darkness
•
Add to my program : Add an app to my program list. With this feature, user
can set default settings, destinations required for each program. Also can set
default options as Auto Launch, add shortcut to Home.
•
Search : Search for a desired options.
Adjusting the brightness
to show the slider control.
Sub menu (Action overflow)
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
110
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
•
•
•
•
•
Build Job : This option can be turned on or off. When this option is on:After
the scanning is finished, the Scan More window appears to ask if you want
to scan another page. If you select Yes, then you can scan another page in
the current job. If you select No, then the scanning process is completed and
the remainder of the job is performed.
If the report contains characters or fonts that the machine does not support,
then Unknown may appear in the report instead of the characters/fonts.
Attach File Only : Allows you to attach a file to your message. You can use
this option to quickly send one or more files from the hard disk drive (BOX)
of the machine to an SMB, FTP, Email, Box, USB.
Save as Default : Allows you to save the current Scan & Send settings as the
default Scan & Send settings. After you save the default Scan & Send
settings, all future send tasks use these settings. Tap this option in the Action
Overflow menu to save the current settings as the default Scan & Send
settings.
Restore Default : Allows you to restore the Scan & Send settings to the
default Scan & Send settings of the machine. This option changes the
current Scan & Send settings to the original settings configured at the
factory. Tap this option in the Action Overflow menu to restore the default
Scan & Send settings.
•
-
+Me Setting: Allows you to select the default destination for the send
job. When logged in, you can select your any Send destination as the
default send destination. Same will appear in Scan & Send widgets too.
-
Send to PC: Scans and sends scanned output to a computer.
Address Book Settings: This address book contains contacts that are
available to all users. You can use the address book to make contacts
available to anyone who uses the machine.
-
•
Google Address Book: This address book contains the contacts
registered in your Google contacts list. You must log into your Google
account to access your Google Address Book.
UI Configuration: Allows you to select the options that appear in the Scan
& Send menu. Tap the + or - symbol on the menu icons to add or remove
menus. You can also tap and hold a menu icon to move it to a different
position or tap Clear All to remove all the menus.
Send Settings : Allows you to quickly scan a document and send it to a
destination. The scanned document is sent as an image file. Tap this option
in the sub menu (action overflow menu) to scan and attach a file to the
current message.
-
Filing Policy: The Filing Policy setting specifies how the machine
handles name conflicts when saving files.
-
Print Confirmation Report: You can use this feature to get
confirmation on executed Scan & Send destination's successfully or
not.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
111
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
Job progress
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
This menu appears whenever the machine is processing a job.
• Click the
•
Detail : Tap this button to see the status, destination, sender, and time of the
job.
•
Preview Area : Allows you to see a preview of the document being sent. The
image in the preview area indicates the current send settings, such as the
orientation and size of the file.
•
Send Feedback : Allows you to send feedback about the current send job.
If you want to receive sending job by email, you can set from My page app
(see "Understanding the My Page menu" on page 37).
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
Add Destination
Tap
to add a recipient’s email address or a fax number. If you want to send
to SMB, FTP, Box, PC, or USB click on respective buttons.
Original
To use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Log-in"
on page 280).
Setting options
You can set a detail options in the Send tab and More tab.
• You can customize the UI of each tab using UI configuration option
(Send >
Sub menu(action overflow) > UI Configuration).
This setting is used to improve the scan quality by selecting the document type
for the current scan job.
•
1 Sided: For originals that are printed on one side only.
•
2 Sided, Book: For originals that are printed on both sides.
•
2 Sided, Calendar : For originals that are printed on both sides, but the back
is rotated 180 degrees.
To use 2 Sided, Book and 2 Sided, Calendar, load the originals on the
DSDF. If the machine cannot detect the original on the DSDF, it
automatically changes to 1 Sided.
• Some menus are disabled. If so, it is not available to your machine.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
112
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
Scan Options
-
Set file options of the scanned output.
Ultra Fine: Recommended for originals containing extremely fine
details. This option is only available if the receiving machine also
supports Ultra Fine resolution.
•
File Name: Enter a file name to store the scan file name at destination.
•
File Format: Select a file format for the scanned output.
•
PDF Options: Set PDF file options for the scanned out.
•
Resolution: Adjust the document resolution. The higher this value, the
clearer the result, but scan time may take longer.
•
Quality: Use this option to produce a high quality document. The higher
quality you select, the larger file size.
•
Off: Disable this feature.
•
Left Page: Scans only the left page of the book.
OCR Language: When producing scanned output for OCR software, select
the appropriate language.
•
Right Page: Scans only the right page of the book.
•
Both Pages(From Left): Scans both facing pages from the left page.
Fax Options
•
Both Pages(From Right): Scans both facing pages from the right page.
If you send originals that are of poor quality, or contain photographs, you can
adjust the resolution to produce a higher quality fax.
•
Book Center & Edge Erase: You can set shaded areas to erase shadows
caused by bindings or book edges from the center and side edges of copies.
•
•
Book Scan
Use this feature to scan a book. If the book is too thick, lift the DSDF until its
hinges are engaged by the stopper, then close the DSDF. If the book or
magazine is thicker than 30 mm (1.18 inches), start copying with the DSDF open.
Resolution
-
Standard: Usually recommended for originals with text. This option will
reduce the transmission time.
-
Fine: Recommended for the originals containing small characters, thin
lines, or text from a dot-matrix printer.
-
Super Fine: Recommended for originals containing fine details. This
option is only available if the receiving machine also supports Super
Fine resolution.
Advanced Fax (fax user only)
Set the sending options for fax, such as Quick Start Fax and Delay Send.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Quick Start Fax: The machine will begin to transmit the fax right after the
first page has been scanned. Originals with many pages can be sent this way
without overflowing the machine’s memory.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
113
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
•
Delay Send: Set your machine to send a fax at scheduled time. Define the
Job Name and Start Time.
Original Size
Use this option to set the actual paper size of the originals.
You can delay a fax by any length of time starting 1 minute and 24 hours
after the scan.
•
Mixed Size: Automatically detect the size of original if the original uses a
combination of different paper types.
•
Custom size: If you need to set a custom value for a special size of paper, use
the arrows to set the required size.
Email Settings
Original Orientation
Set email information, such as From, Subject and Message.
Use this option to set the orientation of the original.
Original Type
Use this setting to improve copy quality by selecting the appropriate document
type for the current job.
•
Text: Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo: Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
•
Photo: Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
•
Upright Images: The original is in landscape orientation. The images or text
in the original are parallel to the long edge of the page.
•
Sideways Images: The original is in portrait orientation. The images or text
in the original are perpendicular to the long edge of the page.
Color Mode
Use this option to set the default color mode used for copy jobs.
•
Mono: Displays an image in black and white.
•
Gray: Displays an image in gray.
•
Color: Displays an image in color.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
114
Understanding the Scan & Send screen
The file format JPEG cannot be selected in the File Format option, if Mono
has been selected for Color Mode.
Image Adjustment
Background Adjustment
This option allows you to compensate for originals that contain color in the
background, such as newspapers or catalogs. You can use the options in this
menu to make the copies easier to read.
•
Background Density: Allows you to adjust the density of the background
in the scanned image. This feature is useful when scanning originals that
have turned yellow from age or originals with a dark background.
•
Backside Image: Allows you to erase any text or images that show through
from the other side of the original. You can use this feature to ensure that
your scanned output is clearly legible.
This option allows you to manually adjust the image.
•
Darkness: Allows you to adjust the darkness of the scanned output file. This
feature is useful when scanning faded originals or originals with little
contrast.
•
Sharpness: Allows you to adjust the edges of text so that it is easier to read.
You can also use this feature to enhance the details of images.
•
Contrast: allows you to adjust the contrast to make the scanned output
crisper or smoother. You can use this feature to improve the quality of an
image or increase the readability of text.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
115
Basic scan
This is the usual procedure to scan your original documents.
1
2
Tap Scan & Send from the home screen or Apps.
3
4
Adjust the settings in the Send tab and More tab.
Place the originals face up in the DSDF or place a single original face
down on the scanner glass and close the DSDF (see "Loading originals"
on page 45).
Select a destination using
(Add Destination), + Me,
book), Email , SMB, FTP, Box, or USB).
(Address
You can send scanned documents to Email, Fax, FTP, or SMB addresses
through the
(Address book). The Email, Fax, FTP, or SMB icons appear
next to the contact's name in the Address book. When you select a name,
the first icon is selected by default. To send documents to multiple
destinations, select the icons for each of the destinations.
5
Tap
,
(Start) from the control panel to begin scan.
To cancel the current send job, tap
(Stop), then tap Job Status on the
control panel, and then delete the job you want (see "Job Status" on page
34).
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
116
Scanning with TWAIN-enabled software
If you want to scan documents using other software, you need to use TWAINcompliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop.
Follow the steps below to scan with TWAIN-compliant software:
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
Place the originals face up in the DSDF or place a single original face
down on the scanner glass and close the DSDF (see "Loading originals"
on page 45).
3
4
5
Open an application, such as Adobe Photoshop.
Open the TWAIN window and set the scan options.
Scan and save your scanned images.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
117
Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
Samsung Easy Document Creator is an application to help users scan, compile,
and save documents in multiple formats (including .epub). These documents
can be shared over social networking sites or fax. Whether you’re a student
organizing research from a library or a stay-at-home parent sharing scanned
pictures from last year’s birthday party, Easy Document Creator will provide you
with the necessary tools.
Click
(Help) in the upper-right corner of the window, then click on any
option you want to know more about.
2
Scanning with Samsung Easy Document Creator
• Available for Windows OS only.
• Requires Windows XP or higher and Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher.
• Samsung Easy Document Creator is installed automatically when you
install the machine software.
Samsung Easy Document Creator is an application to help users scan, compile,
and save documents in multiple formats, including .epub format.
1
Place a single document face down on the document glass, or load the
documents face up into the document feeder (see "Loading originals" on
page 45).
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
From the Windows Start menu, click Programs or All Programs.
The Samsung Easy Document Creator provides the following features:
•
Image Scanning: Use to scan single or multiple pictures.
•
Document Scanning: Use to scan documents with text or text andimages.
•
Text Converting: Use to scan documents that need to be saved in an
editable text format.
•
Book Scanning: Use to scan books with the flatbed scanner.
•
SNS Upload: Use to quickly and easily upload scanned images or existing
images to a variety of social networking sites (SNS).
•
E-Book Conversion: Use to scan multiple documents together as one ebook or combine existing files into an e-book.
•
Plug-in: Scan and fax directly from the Microsoft Office program.
Click Samsung Printers, and run Samsung Easy Document Creator.
Click Scan from the home screen.
Select the type of scanning or a favorites then click Start.
Make adjustments to the image (Scan Settings and More Options).
Click Scan to scan a final image or Prescan to get another preview.
Select Save to Location, Send to E-mail, or Send to SNS.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
118
Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
9
Click Save (to save the scanned image), Send (to email the scanned
image), or Share (to upload the scanned image).
If there is room on the scanning glass, you can scan more than one item at
a time. Use the
tool to define multiple selection areas.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
119
Mac scanning
3
4
Scanning from USB connected machine
1
2
3
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
Place a single document face down on the document glass, or load the
documents face up into the document feeder (see "Loading originals" on
page 45).
Start Applications and click Image Capture.
Scanning from network connected machine
1
2
Make sure that your machine is connected to a network.
3
4
Start Applications and click Image Capture.
Place a single document face down on the document glass, or load the
documents face up into the document feeder (see "Loading originals" on
page 45).
According to OS, follow steps below.
•
If No Image Capture device connected message appears, disconnect the
USB cable and reconnect it. If the problem continues, refer to the Image
Capture’s help.
•
4
5
Select the option you want.
Scan and save your scanned image.
If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to the latest
version.
5
6
For 10.5
-
Click Devices > Browse Devices on Menu bar.
-
Make sure that Connected checkbox is checked beside your
machine in Bonjour Devices.
For 10.6 -10.9, select your device below SHARED.
Set the scan options on this program.
Scan and save your scanned image.
• If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to the latest version.
•
For more information, refer to the Image Capture’s help.
•
You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop.
• You can scan using Samsung Scan Assistant software. Open the Applications folder >
Samsung folder > Samsung Scan Assistant.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
120
Linux scanning
5
Scanning
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and
powered on.
2
Launch a scan application such as xsane or simple-scan(If it's not
installed, please install it manually to use scan features. For example, you
may use "yum install xsane" for rpm package systems and "apt-get install
xsane" for deb package systems to install xsane).
3
4
Select your device from the list and set the scan options to apply.
Click the Scan button.
5. Scan & Send(Scanning)
121
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
This guide gives you information about using your machine as a fax machine.
This chapter includes:
• Preparing to fax
123
• Using a fax in your computer
124
• Understanding the fax screen
126
• Sending a fax
135
• Receiving a fax
137
Preparing to fax
• You cannot use this machine as a fax through the internet phone. For
more information, ask your internet service provider.
• We recommend you use traditional analog phone services like PSTN
(public switched telephone network) when using a phone line as a fax
line. If you use internet services (DSL, ISDN, VolP), you can improve the
connection quality by using a micro-filter. A micro-filter reduces noise
and improves connection quality. Since a DSL micro-filter is not provided
with the machine, contact your internet service provider.
1 Line port
2 Micro filter
3 DSL modem / Telephone line
Before you send or receive a fax, you must connect the supplied cord to the wall
jack. Refer to “Quick installation guide”. The method of connecting a telephone
line varies by country.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
123
Using a fax in your computer
You can send a fax directly from your computer. Make sure that your machine
and the computer are connected to the same network.
2
Checking a sent fax list (Windows)
You can check a sent fax list on your computer.
1
Sending a fax (Windows)
To send a fax from your computer, the Samsung Network PC Fax program
must be installed. You can install the Samsung Network PC Fax driver from the
software CD. You can select the Samsung Network PC Fax driver in the Select
Software window.
1
2
3
Select Print from the File menu.
Select Samsung Network PC Fax from the Print window
Click Print or OK.
Sending a fax (Mac)
To send a fax from your computer, the Fax Utilities program must be installed.
This program is installed when you install the printer driver.
The following steps are based on the Mac OS X 10.5 or 10.6. Depending on the
OS version, the following steps may be different. Before sending a fax, add a fax
driver using Fax Queue Creator.
Enter the recipient’s fax number and set any options if necessary.
For more information about Samsung Network PC Fax, click Help.
6
For more information about Fax Transmission History, click Help.
Open the document you want to send.
The Print window will be displayed. It may look slightly different
depending on your application.
3
4
5
From the Start menu, click Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers >
Network PC Fax > Fax Transmission History. Then, the Fax Journal appears
with the fax list you have sent.
Click Send.
1
2
3
Open the document you want to send.
Select Print from the File menu.
Select a fax driver from the Printer list.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
124
Using a fax in your computer
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Choose the number of copies and pages.
Choose your paper size, orientation, and scale.
Enter the recipients’ fax number in To input box. If you have stored
frequently-used fax numbers, you can also use Addresses by pressing
the
button.
If necessary, enter the access code in Dialing Prefix.
If necessary, check Use Cover page to send the fax with a cover page.
Enter the subject and message of the fax job.
Click Fax.
The Fax Queue icon (
) appears on your Mac dock. Click the icon to
see the status of the fax job. You can also delete, hold, pause and resume
jobs from this window.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
125
Understanding the fax screen
Tap Scan & Send from the home screen or Apps, then tap
screen. If you see a different screen, tap the
to open the Fax
Command keys
icon to go to the home screen.
Button
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
• You can set the general options (see "Setting options" on page 112).
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menu.
Address book
Open your saved address book.
Fax
Send a fax.
My Program
Add an app to my program list.
4
Send tab
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow)
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
126
Understanding the fax screen
Button
Name
+ Me
Description
When users are logged in, the destination
configured in their My Page profile appears.You
can set the destination in the Send to
Destination menu of the My Page app (see
"Understanding the My Page menu" on page 37).
Administrators can also set the default
destination in the sub menu (Action overflow) >
Send Settings > +Me Setting.
You must log in to use your + Me
destination. If you do not log in, then the
machine sends the copy to the + Me
destination specified by the
administrator.
Button
Name
Description
Reset
Reset to app default configuration.
On Hook
When you press this button, you can hear a dial tone.
Then enter a fax number. It is similar to making a call
using speaker phone.
Stop
Stop a job at any time. A popup window appears to
show the jobs that you can stop.
Start
Start a job.
Preview
Preview displays the original scanned image.
Virtual Hard Key
Button
Name
Description
Setting
History
View changed options list.
Preview for
status
Shows the job preview.
• The positon of virtual hard keys is fixed on the right side of screen.
• When an app is launched, the virtual hard keys are shown.
• If the screen is touched, the virtual hard keys always appear.
• If the
,
touched, the virtual hard keys are hidden and shown.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
127
Understanding the fax screen
Button
Name
Preview for
play
Description
Scans for job.
Selecting the color mode
Use one of the following options to use for the scan.
: This button appears to edit when
scanning. Adjust the prescanned image
with operation functions such as rotate
and crop.
•
Mono: Use black and white (1-bit per pixel).
•
Gray : Use grayscale (8-bit per pixel).
•
Color : Use color (24-bit per pixel, each of the RGB channels has 8 bits).
Selecting the original type
Start
Starts a job.
Use the original type setting to improve copy quality by selecting the
appropriate document type for a copy job.
•
Text : Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo : Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
You can adjust the brightness level of a copy if needed for easier reading if the
original contains faint markings or dark images. Adjust the brightness level
using the slider. This feature allows you to print dark images lighter, or light
images darker.
•
Photo : Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
Tap Darkness
•
Add to my program : Add an app to my program list. With this feature, user
can set default settings, destinations required for each program. Also can set
default options as Auto Launch, add shortcut to Home.
•
Search : Search for a desired options.
Adjusting the brightness
to show the slider control.
Sub menu (Action overflow)
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
128
Understanding the fax screen
•
•
•
•
•
Build Job : This option can be turned on or off. When this option is on:After
the scanning is finished, the Scan More window appears to ask if you want
to scan another page. If you select Yes, then you can scan another page in
the current job. If you select No, then the scanning process is completed and
the remainder of the job is performed.
If the report contains characters or fonts that the machine does not support,
then Unknown may appear in the report instead of the characters/fonts.
Attach File Only : Allows you to attach a file to your message. You can use
this option to quickly send one or more files from the hard disk drive (BOX)
of the machine to an SMB, FTP, Email, Box, USB.
Save as Default : Allows you to save the current Scan & Send settings as the
default Scan & Send settings. After you save the default Scan & Send
settings, all future send tasks use these settings. Tap this option in the Action
Overflow menu to save the current settings as the default Scan & Send
settings.
Restore Default : Allows you to restore the Scan & Send settings to the
default Scan & Send settings of the machine. This option changes the
current Scan & Send settings to the original settings configured at the
factory. Tap this option in the Action Overflow menu to restore the default
Scan & Send settings.
•
-
+Me Setting: Allows you to select the default destination for the send
job. When logged in, you can select your any Send destination as the
default send destination. Same will appear in Scan & Send widgets too.
-
Send to PC: Scans and sends scanned output to a computer.
Address Book Settings: This address book contains contacts that are
available to all users. You can use the address book to make contacts
available to anyone who uses the machine.
-
•
Google Address Book: This address book contains the contacts
registered in your Google contacts list. You must log into your Google
account to access your Google Address Book.
UI Configuration: Allows you to select the options that appear in the Scan
& Send menu. Tap the + or - symbol on the menu icons to add or remove
menus. You can also tap and hold a menu icon to move it to a different
position or tap Clear All to remove all the menus.
Send Settings : Allows you to quickly scan a document and send it to a
destination. The scanned document is sent as an image file. Tap this option
in the sub menu (action overflow menu) to scan and attach a file to the
current message.
-
Filing Policy: The Filing Policy setting specifies how the machine
handles name conflicts when saving files.
-
Print Confirmation Report: You can use this feature to get
confirmation on executed Scan & Send destination's successfully or
not.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
129
Understanding the fax screen
Job progress
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
This menu appears whenever the machine is processing a job.
• Click the
•
Detail : Tap this button to see the status, destination, sender, and time of the
job.
•
Preview Area : Allows you to see a preview of the document being sent. The
image in the preview area indicates the current send settings, such as the
orientation and size of the file.
•
Send Feedback : Allows you to send feedback about the current send job.
If you want to receive sending job by email, you can set from My page app
(see "Understanding the My Page menu" on page 37).
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
Add Destination
Tap
to add a recipient’s email address or a fax number. If you want to send
to SMB, FTP, Box, PC, or USB click on respective buttons.
Original
To use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Log-in"
on page 280).
Setting options
You can set a detail options in the Send tab and More tab.
• You can customize the UI of each tab using UI configuration option
(Send >
Sub menu(action overflow) > UI Configuration).
This setting is used to improve the scan quality by selecting the document type
for the current scan job.
•
1 Sided: For originals that are printed on one side only.
•
2 Sided, Book: For originals that are printed on both sides.
•
2 Sided, Calendar : For originals that are printed on both sides, but the back
is rotated 180 degrees.
To use 2 Sided, Book and 2 Sided, Calendar, load the originals on the
DSDF. If the machine cannot detect the original on the DSDF, it
automatically changes to 1 Sided.
• Some menus are disabled. If so, it is not available to your machine.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
130
Understanding the fax screen
Scan Options
-
Set file options of the scanned output.
•
File Name: Enter a file name to store the scan file name at destination.
•
File Format: Select a file format for the scanned output.
•
Resolution: Adjust the document resolution. The higher this value, the
clearer the result, but scan time may take longer.
•
Quality: Use this option to produce a high quality document. The higher
quality you select, the larger file size.
•
OCR Language: When producing scanned output for OCR software, select
the appropriate language. This is supported when Searchable PDF option is
selected in File Format settings.
Fax Options
If you send originals that are of poor quality, or contain photographs, you can
adjust the resolution to produce a higher quality fax.
•
Ultra Fine: Recommended for originals containing extremely fine
details. This option is only available if the receiving machine also
supports Ultra Fine resolution.
Book Scan
Use this feature to scan a book. If the book is too thick, lift the DSDF until its
hinges are engaged by the stopper, then close the DSDF. If the book or
magazine is thicker than 30 mm (1.18 inches), start copying with the DSDF open.
•
Off: Disable this feature.
•
Left Page: Scans only the left page of the book.
•
Right Page: Scans only the right page of the book.
•
Both Pages(From Left): Scans both facing pages from the left page.
•
Both Pages(From Right): Scans both facing pages from the right page.
•
Book Center & Edge Erase: You can set shaded areas to erase shadows
caused by bindings or book edges from the center and side edges of copies.
Resolution
-
Standard: Usually recommended for originals with text. This option will
reduce the transmission time.
-
Fine: Recommended for the originals containing small characters, thin
lines, or text from a dot-matrix printer.
-
Super Fine: Recommended for originals containing fine details. This
option is only available if the receiving machine also supports Super
Fine resolution.
Advanced Fax (fax user only)
Set the sending options for fax, such as Quick Start Fax and Delay Send.
•
Off: Disables this feature.
•
Quick Start Fax: The machine will begin to transmit the fax right after the
first page has been scanned. Originals with many pages can be sent this way
without overflowing the machine’s memory.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
131
Understanding the fax screen
•
Delay Send: Set your machine to send a fax at scheduled time. Define the
Job Name and Start Time.
Original Size
Use this option to set the actual paper size of the originals.
You can delay a fax by any length of time starting 1 minute and 24 hours
after the scan.
•
Mixed Size: Automatically detect the size of original if the original uses a
combination of different paper types.
•
Custom size: If you need to set a custom value for a special size of paper, use
the arrows to set the required size.
Email Settings
Original Orientation
Set email information, such as From, Subject and Message.
Use this option to set the orientation of the original.
Original Type
Use this setting to improve copy quality by selecting the appropriate document
type for the current job.
•
Text: Use if the original is mostly text and very few or no images.
•
Text/Photo: Use if the original is a mix of text and images.
•
Photo: Use if the original is mostly or exclusively images.
•
Upright Images: The original is in landscape orientation. The images or text
in the original are parallel to the long edge of the page.
•
Sideways Images: The original is in portrait orientation. The images or text
in the original are perpendicular to the long edge of the page.
Color Mode
Use this option to set the default color mode used for copy jobs.
•
Mono: Displays an image in black and white.
•
Gray: Displays an image in gray.
•
Color: Displays an image in color.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
132
Understanding the fax screen
Background Adjustment
JPEG file format cannot be selected if color mode is set as MONO.
Image Adjustment
This option allows you to compensate for originals that contain color in the
background, such as newspapers or catalogs. You can use the options in this
menu to make the copies easier to read.
•
Background Density: Allows you to adjust the density of the background
in the scanned image. This feature is useful when scanning originals that
have turned yellow from age or originals with a dark background.
•
Backside Image: Allows you to erase any text or images that show through
from the other side of the original. You can use this feature to ensure that
your scanned output is clearly legible.
This option allows you to manually adjust the image.
•
Darkness: Allows you to adjust the darkness of the scanned output file. This
feature is useful when scanning faded originals or originals with little
contrast.
•
Sharpness: Allows you to adjust the edges of text so that it is easier to read.
You can also use this feature to enhance the details of images.
•
Contrast: allows you to adjust the contrast to make the scanned output
crisper or smoother. You can use this feature to improve the quality of an
image or increase the readability of text.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
133
Understanding the fax screen
5
Button
Fax screen
Name
Description
Groups
Open a list of group addresses.
Contacts
Open a list of your contacts.
Pause
Pause the current job.
Add Contacts
Add a new contact to your addresses.
Add To
Add to the destination list.
Destination List
Open the destination list.
On Hook
Enable On Hook dialing. When you hear the dial
tone, enter a fax number using the numeric
keypad on the screen.
Send
Send the fax.
Command keys
Button
Name
Description
keypad
Open the keypad.
Favorites
Open a list of frequently-used addresses.
Recent
View any recently-used addresses.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
134
Sending a fax
This section explains how to send a fax and the special methods of transmission.
8
Tap
or select other settings.
7
You can place the originals use either the DSDF or the scanner glass. If the
originals are placed on both the DSDF and the scanner glass, the machine
will read the originals on the DSDF first, because it has higher scan priority.
Sending a fax
1
Place the originals face up in the DSDF or place a single original face
down on the scanner glass and close the DSDF (see "Loading originals"
on page 45).
2
3
4
Tap Send from the home screen or Apps.
6
Setting the fax header
In some countries, you are required by law to specify your fax number on any fax
you send.
1
Tap Settings > Fax Settings > Machine ID & Fax No on the display
screen.
2
3
Tap the ID Name input box. The pop-up keyboard appears.
4
5
6
7
Adjust the document settings in the Send tab or More tab.
Tap
and enter a fax number directly using
on the screen, then tap
or using Favorites, Recent, Groups, Contacts tap from the display
screen.
• You can send a fax up to 10 destinations at once.
Enter your name or the company name (see "Understanding the pop-up
keyboard" on page 38).
• You can view and delete a destination from Destination List (
).
• To insert a pause, tap
while entering the fax number. A dash (-)
appears on the display when a pause is inserted.
Tap Done.
• If you want to use On Hook dial, tap
and enter a fax number using
the numeric keypad on the screen while you hear the dial tone.
Tap the Fax Number input box.
Enter your fax number using the numeric keypad on the control panel.
Tap Done.
5
Tap
to start the process.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
135
Sending a fax
• You can send a fax directly from your computer (see "Using a fax in your
computer" on page 124).
To change the time interval between redials and/or the number of redial
attempts, follow the steps below:
Tap Settings > Fax Settings > Redial on the display screen.
• When you want to cancel a fax job, tap
(Stop) from virtual hard key
before the machine starts transmission. Or tap Job Status from the
home screen or Apps, select the job you want to delete (see "Job Status"
on page 34).
• You cannot send emails with the machine while it is sending a fax.
Sending a fax using speed dial numbers
Delaying a fax transmission
You can set your machine to send a fax at a later time (see "General fax settings"
on page 139).
To cancel a delayed fax, tap Off before it is sent.
When you are prompted to enter a destination number for your fax, you can use
a speed dial number previously set by you.
• 1-500 can be assigned for the speed dial numbers
• For one-digit speed dial numbers, press and hold the corresponding
number on the numeric keypad on the control panel.
• For two or more digit speed dial numbers, press the first digit button and
hold the last number on the numeric keypad on the control panel.
Resending automatically
If the line is busy or there is no answer when you send a fax, the machine
automatically redials the number.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
136
Receiving a fax
This section explains how to receive faxes, and the special options available.
9
Receiving manually in Telephone mode
8
Changing Receive Mode
You can receive a fax call by pressing On Hook and then pressing
Your machine is preset to Fax mode at the factory. When you receive a fax, the
machine answers the call after a specified number of rings and automatically
receives the fax. If you want to change to another receive mode, follow the steps
below:
Tap Settings > Fax Settings > Receive Mode on the display screen.
•
Telephone: Receive faxes by pressing On Hook and then
(Start) from
virtual hard key.
•
Fax: Receive incoming faxes normally and immediately enter the fax
reception mode.
•
Answering Machine/Fax: Use when an answering machine is attached to
your machine. Your machine answers the incoming call, and the caller can
leave a message on the answering machine. If the fax machine senses a fax
tone on the line, the machine automatically switches to Fax mode to receive
the fax.
(Start)
from virtual hard key when you hear a fax tone from the remote machine. The
machine begins receiving a fax.
10
Receiving automatically in Answering Machine/Fax
mode
To use this mode, you must attach an answering machine to the EXT socket on
the back of your machine.
If the caller leaves a message, the answering machine records the message as
normal. If your machine detects a fax tone on the line, it automatically starts to
receive the fax.
• Receive start code: When you receive a call on the extension phone and
hear fax tones, press the keys *9* on the extension phone. The machine
receives the fax. Press the buttons slowly in sequence. If you still hear the
fax tone from the remote machine, try pressing *9* once again.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
137
Receiving a fax
• If you have set your machine to this mode and your answering machine
is turned off, or no answering machine is connected to the EXT socket,
your machine automatically enters Fax mode after a predefined number
of rings.
2
When the machine receives a fax in this mode, Print option becomes
available. If you want to print the secured faxes, tap Print. All secured faxes
will then be printed.
• If your answering machine has a configurable ring counter, set it to
answer incoming calls before it rings more than once.
• If you are in Telephone mode when the answering machine is
connected to your machine, you must switch off the answering machine.
Otherwise, outgoing messages from the answering machine will
interrupt your phone conversations.
Tab On to enable this feature.
3
If you want to set a passcode, tab the passcode blank and enter a
passcode.
4
If you want incoming faxes to be always saved to memory, tap Whole
Day. Otherwise, proceed to the next step.
5
Tap Start Time and set the specific start time using the up/down
buttons. Tap Set when finished.
6
Tap End Time and set the specific end time using the up/down buttons.
Tap Set when finished.
7
Tap
11
Receiving in Secure Receive mode
You may need to prevent your received faxes from being accessed by
unauthorized people. You can turn on secure receiving mode to restrict printing
of incoming faxes when the machine is unattended. In Secure Receive mode, all
incoming faxes are saved to memory.
1
Tap Settings > Fax Settings > Secure Receive on the display screen.
or select other settings.
To deactivate the Secure Receive feature, tap Off. Incoming faxes will be
automatically printed again.
Secure Receive mode can only be configured by a user with a registered
passcode on the machine. When the machine requests, enter your
passcode.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
138
Receiving a fax
12
14
Setting Received Fax Printing
General fax settings
Use this option to set printing options for received faxes.
You can set the default fax options. Set the most frequently-used fax settings.
Tap Settings > Fax Settings > Received Fax Printing on the display screen.
Tap Settings > Fax Settings on the display screen.
•
Duplex: The machine prints received faxes on both sides of the paper.
•
Output Tray: Specify the tray where the fax is printed.
•
Auto Reduction: Set to reduce the size of incoming pages automatically.
When receiving a fax containing pages as long as or longer than the paper
loaded in the paper tray, the machine can reduce the size of the original to
fit the size of the paper loaded in the machine. If you do not enable this
option, the machine cannot reduce the original to fit onto one page. The
original will be divided and printed in actual size on two or more pages.
•
Printing Large Pages: Use to fit where faxes are printed.
•
Stamp Received Name: Print the received fax information on printouts.
•
Paper Source: Select a tray as the paper source.
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
• Click the
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
• You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open a
web browser from a networked computer and type the IP address of your
machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Settings tab >
Machine Settings > Fax (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
Option
Machine ID & Fax No
13
(Help) from the home screen or
Description
You can set the machine ID and fax number to
be printed at the top of each page.
Forwarding faxes
You can set your machine to forward sent or received faxes to email, SMB, FTP,
and so on. If you are out of the office but need to receive faxes, this feature may
be useful.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
139
Receiving a fax
Option
Redial
Description
Set the machine to re-dial the fax number if
the recipient’s fax line is busy or not answered.
Set the number of re-dial attempts and the
interval between attempts.
Option
Receive Mode
• Fax: Receive incoming faxes normally and
immediately enter the fax reception mode.
• Answering Machine/Fax: Use when an
answering machine is attached to your
machine. Your machine answers the
incoming call, and the caller can leave a
message on the answering machine. If the
fax machine senses a fax tone on the line,
the machine automatically switches to Fax
mode to receive the fax.
• Redial Times: Select a re-dial time using
the up/down arrows. Select 0 to disable
redialing.
ECM Mode
Modem Speed
Set the number to be dialed before the
destination number. Users may use this to
access a PABX (e.g. 9) or an area code (e.g. 02).
Once this number is set, it automatically
appears on the screen when entering a
phone/fax number.
Set the machine to correct errors. This helps
overcome poor line quality and ensures any
faxes you send are properly transmitted to any
other error correction-equipped fax machine.
Sending a fax in this mode may take more
time.
Set the modem speed (4.8Kbps - 33.6Kbps).
Select the fax receiving mode.
• Telephone: Press On Hook Dial and then
Start to receive a fax.
• Redial Term: Select terms for re-dialing
using the up/down arrows.
Prefix Dial
Description
Ring to Answer
Set the number of times the machine rings
before answering an incoming call.
Toll Save
Set the machine to send faxes in the toll save
time to reduce phone bill costs.
DRPD Mode
Enable a user to answer several different
phone numbers on the same telephone line.
Set the machine to recognize different ring
patterns for each number. This setting may
not be available in your country.
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
140
Receiving a fax
Option
Junk Fax Setup
Secure Receivea
Description
Use this feature to reject faxes sent from
numbers stored in memory as junk fax
numbers. This feature is useful to block any
unwanted faxes. When you turn this feature
on, you can access additional options to set
junk fax numbers. This option may not be
available in your country.
Set the machine to save the received faxes in
memory so that unauthorized people cannot
access them when you are absent. This option
restricts printing of received faxes when the
machine is unattended.
• Off: Select to not use secure receive.
• On: Select to use secure receive.
• Print: Select to print faxes in the memory.
You need to log-in as an administrator to
print out received faxes in memory.
Received Fax Printing
Set options to print received faxes.
Fax Country Setting
Select a country as default. Before changing
this, connect a telephone line to the machine.
When you change the country, a ping test is
performed.
Option
Smart Fax Diagnostics
Description
The Smart Fax feature optimizes the settings
for your fax line.
• Auto Configuration: When sending and
receiving faxes, the machine regularly
checks for errors and automatically
configures the fax settings to ensure a
stable connection.
• Start: Allows you to automatically detect
or manually specify the environment when
sending or receiving faxes. Select Auto
Detection to automatically detect the
environment, or manually specify the
faxing environment as Normal,
VoIP(Office), Noise(Home), or Big Noise.
• Initialize Diagnostics Settings: Resets all
the settings.
a. May only be available for the administrator depending on the authentication settings
selected (see "Authentication" on page 289).
6. Scan & Send(Faxing)
141
7. Setting up an Address
Book
This guide gives you guidelines for the address book.
This chapter includes:
• Understanding the address screen
143
• Using the control panel
145
• Using SyncThru™ Web Service
149
Understanding the address screen
The Address book app allows you to access and save frequently used addresses
in the machine. You can save fax numbers and email addresses as well as
addresses for SMB, FTP,and so on.
Tap Address book from the home screen or Apps. If want to go home, tap the
home(
) button.
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
1
Address screen
You can save frequently used fax numbers, e-mail addresses, SMB server
addresses, FTP server addresses in your machine.
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
• You can set general options (see "Setting options" on page 112).
•
Contacts: Displays the name and contact information of contacts saved in
the address book.
•
Favorites: Displays the name and contact information of contacts marked
as favorites in the address book.
•
Groups: Lists the groups registered in the address book and the users
registered to those groups.
7. Setting up an Address Book
143
Understanding the address screen
Sub menu (Action overflow)
You cannot add a group as a member of another group.
To use some features, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Login" on page 280).
Command keys
To use some features, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Login" on page 280).
Button
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Show the quick menu.
Search
Search for a desired address.
Add
Add a contact, favorite, or group.
Edit
Select the address you want to edit and tap this
button.
My Program
Shows list of added programs.
•
Search: Searches the names and contact information in the Contacts list.
•
Delete Contacts: Delete the contacts you set.
•
Import: You can import the address book saved from another MFP or same
MFP.
•
Export: You can export the address book saved from another MFP or same
MFP.
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow)
7. Setting up an Address Book
144
Using the control panel
6
2
Storing individual addresses
1
Tap Address book on the home screen or Apps> Tap
display screen.
2
Tap the Name input box, and then enter the name of the recipient.
• If the SMB server you entered is not registered to any domain, leave it
blank or enter the computer name of the SMB server.
Tab
• User Login Name: Select this option to create a sub-folder in the file
folder you selected. The sub-folder is named according to the user name
entered in step 5. If the file folder already has a sub-folder of the same
name, the machine does not create a sub-folder.
3
4
(add) on the
Tap the SMB or FTP input boxes to enter that information of the
recipient.
(favorite) icon for addresses you use often and want to find easily.
Tap the Email input boxes to enter that information of the recipient.
Speed No. is automatically assigned with the first number of unused
numbers.
• If you want a SMB or FTP server to allow anonymous connections, select
the Anonymous from Login Type.
• Folder Creation Cycle: Set the cycle of sub-folder creation. The machine
creates sub-folders according to this option. If the file folder already has
a sub-folder of the same name, the machine does not create a sub-folder.
- Every Day: A sub-folder is created every day using the name format
“YYYY-MM-DD” (for example, “2014-01-01”).
Use the Speed No. on the numeric keypad to select an address quickly.
5
Tap the Fax input box and enter the fax number using the numeric
keypad on the control panel. You can enter only numbers, area code first
if necessary.
Inserting a pause: On some telephone systems, you must dial an access
code (like 9) and listen for a second dial tone before dialing the number. In
such cases, you can insert a pause in the telephone number.
7. Setting up an Address Book
145
Using the control panel
- Every Month: A sub-folder is created every month using the name
format “YYYY-MM” (for example, “2014-01”).
If you want to delete an individual address, check the box of that address
- Every Year: A sub-folder is created every year using the name format
“YYYY” (for example, “2014”).
and tap
• Create Group for Multiple Files: If you select this option and scan
multiple files, the machine creates a sub-folder in the file folder you
selected to store all sent files.
If all folder creation options are enabled at the same time, sent files are
stored as below.
- When a single scanned file is sent:
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOC.jpg
Sub menu (Action overflow) > Delete Contacts.
3
Tap the input field for the information you want to change. The pop-up
keyboard appears, allowing you to type in the field.
4
Tap Done to save the information.
4
- When multiple scanned files are sent:
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC000.jpg
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC001.jpg
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC002.jpg
7
Tap Done to save the information.
3
Editing Individual address
Storing address groups
1
Tap Address book on the home screen or Apps > Groups >
on the display screen.
2
3
Tap the Name input field and enter a name for the group.
When editing a contact, tap a field to change or delete the information, or add
additional fields to the contact’s information.
1
2
Tap Add contact and check the boxes for any addresses you want
include in the group. Tap Done when you are finished.
To search for a contact, tap the search field in the Add contact screen. Enter
the first few letters of a contact’s name or tap the
(search) icon to show
all contacts. In the list that appears, check the boxes for the contacts you
want to add and tap Done.
Tap Address book > Contacts on the home screen or Apps.
Tap the name of individual you want to edit. Tap
(add)
(edit).
4
Tap Done to save the information.
7. Setting up an Address Book
146
Using the control panel
5
6
Editing address groups
1
2
Searching for address book entries
Tap Address book > Groups on the home screen or Apps.
Tap the name of group you want to edit and tap
You can search the addresses that are currently stored in the address book.
(edit).
If you want to delete an address group, check the box for the group you
want to delete and tap
3
4
1
2
Tap Address book > Contacts or Groups on the home screen or Apps.
3
The machine then displays the search results.
Tap the
(search) input field and enter a name or part of a name to
search for.
(delete).
Tap the group name input field to change the name of the group.
Tap Add contact and check the boxes for any addresses you want
include in the group. Tap Done when you are finished.
7
Deleting address book entries
You can delete addresses currently stored in the address book.
To search for a contact, tap the search field in the Add contact screen. Enter
the first few letters of a contact’s name or tap the
(search) icon to show
all contacts. In the list that appears, check the boxes for the contacts you
want to add and tap Done.
5
6
To remove an individual address from the group, check the box for that
address and tap
(delete).
Tap Done to save the information.
To use this feature, you may need to log-in as an administrator (see "Log-in"
on page 280).
1
2
Tap Address book > Contacts or Groups on the home screen or Apps.
Check the boxes of the addresses you want to delete and tap tap
Sub menu (Action overflow) > Delete Contacts.
7. Setting up an Address Book
147
Using the control panel
3
Tap OK in the confirmation window and the selected addresses are
deleted from the address book.
8
Viewing the address book
You can browse for individual addresses and groups.
1
2
Tap Address book on the home screen or Apps.
Tap an address to see more information about it.
You can tap
(edit) when viewing an address to edit its information
directly, or when viewing an address group to see a list of that group’s
members.
7. Setting up an Address Book
148
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
You can store addresses conveniently from the networked computer using
SyncThru™ Web Service. Only for users registered on the machine can store
addresses through login SyncThru™ Web Service.
9
• A Speed Dial Number allows you to enter that number on the numeric
keypad to dial that number quickly.
9
• Check Favorite for addresses you use often. You can easily find them in
search results.
Storing on your local machine
This method allows you to store addresses on your machine’s memory. You can
add addresses and group them into categories.
Adding individual addresses to the address book
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://12.123.123.123)
Enter a name to add and select a speed dial number in the General field.
10
11
12
13
14
15
Enter an email address in the Email field.
Enter a fax number in the Fax field.
Check the enable SMB box in SMB and enter the SMB information.
Enter a server IP address or a host name in SMB Server Address.
Enter a server port number in SMB Server Port.
Enter a login name in Login Name.
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service shows.
If you want to allow anonymous connections to your SMB or FTP server,
check the Anonymous box. This box is unchecked by default. If you
checked the Anonymous box, go to step 18.
Click Login.
Enter your ID and password and select a domain to log in to.
Click Login.
16
Enter a password in Password and re-enter the same password in
Confirm Password.
17
Enter a domain name in Domain.
Click Address Book.
Click Add.
7. Setting up an Address Book
149
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
If the SMB server you entered is not registered to a domain, leave this field
blank or enter the computer name of the SMB server.
18
Enter the scan file folder to store scanned images in Path.
•
Example: /shared_Folder/
19
Select Scan folder creating policy options:
•
Create new folder using login name: If you select this option, the
machine creates a sub-folder in the file folder you selected. The subfolder is named using the user name from step 15.
Day: A sub-folder is created every day using the name format
“YYYY-MM-DD” (for example, “2014-01-01”).
Year: A sub-folder is created every year using the name format
“YYYY” (for example, “2014”).
Create new folder only if scan output consist of several files: If
you select this option and multiple files are scanned, the machine
creates sub-folders in the file folder you selected and the sent files
are stored in the sub-folder.
• When multiple scanned files are sent:
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC000.jpg
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC001.jpg
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOCJPEG\DOC002.jpg
20
-
-
• When a single scanned file is sent:
\\folder\user name\2014-01-01\DOC.jpg
Create new folder every: You can set the cycle of sub-folder
creation. The machine create a sub-folder according to these
options:
If the file folder already has a sub-folder of the same name, the machine
does not create a sub-folder.
Month: A sub-folder is created every month using the name
format “YYYY-MM” (for example, “2014-01”).
If all folder creation options are enabled at the same time, sent files are
stored as below.
If the file folder already has a sub-folder of the same name, the machine
does not create a sub-folder.
•
-
Select the policy for generating file names in Filing Policy. If the server
already contains a file of the same name, the file is processed based on
the following options.
•
Change Name: The sent file is automatically saved as a pre-defined
file name.
•
Cancel: Do not save the sent file.
•
Overwrite: Overwrite the existing file with the newly sent file.
7. Setting up an Address Book
150
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
21
22
23
24
Enter the file name in File Name to store on the server.
To verify that the process is working with your settings, click Test.
Enter FTP server information as you did for SMB.
8
9
10
Check the box for the address you want to edit and click Edit.
Change the address information.
Click Apply.
Click Apply.
Click Undo to reverse any changes you entered. Click Cancel to close the
window without saving any changes.
Click Undo to delete the information you entered. If you click Cancel, the
Add window is closed.
Deleting individual addresses in the address book
Editing individual addresses in the address book
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
5
6
7
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://123.123.123.123).
Click Login.
Enter your ID and password, and select a domain to log in to.
Click Login.
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
5
6
7
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser(for example,
http://123.123.123.123).
Click Login.
Enter your ID and password, and select a domain to log in to.
Click Login.
Click Address Book.
Click Address Book.
7. Setting up an Address Book
151
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
8
Check the boxes of the addresses you want to delete and click Delete.
8
Enter a name or part of a name to search for in the search field.
Check the box at the top of the column to select all addresses.
You can search for addresses in a specific category such as Fax Number,
Email, SMB, and so on.
Click OK in the confirmation window to delete the addresses.
For example, if you want to find a fax number, click the drop down list next
Searching for individual addresses in the address
book
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
5
6
7
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
to
9
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://123.123.123.123)
Click
and select Fax Number.
and the search results appear.
You can see the addresses in a specific category such as Fax Number, Email,
SMB, etc.
For example, if you want to see the addresses which are included fax
number, click drop down list below LDAP and select Fax Number.
Click Login.
Enter your ID and password, and select a domain to log in to.
Click Login.
Click Address Book.
You can sort the address book by clicking each column header. For example,
click Speed No. to sort the addresses by speed dial number. Click a column
a second time to reverse the sort order.
Exporting Address Book
You can import the address book saved in the machine to the computer in CSV
file format using SyncThru™ Web Service.
1
Access the SyncThru™ Web Service (see "SyncThru™ Web Service" on
page 159).
2
Click Address Book tab > Individual.
7. Setting up an Address Book
152
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
3
4
Select Export from the Task drop down list.
- Fax: This field is not mandatory. You can enter up to 40 byte using
numbers (0-9) and special characters (#,*,-).
Select the option you want and click the Export button.
- Email: This field is not mandatory. You can enter up to 128 byte in
email address format (ex: printer@domain.com)
Then the address book file stored in your computer.
Importing Address Book
You can edit the exported address book in CSV file format and send it back to the
machine by exporting to the machine from your computer.
Followings are the conditions for editing the imported CSV file.
• Password-protected or security enhanced CSV file cannot be edited.
• The CSV file needs to be saved in Notepad program in UTF-8.
1
Access the SyncThru™ Web Service (see "SyncThru™ Web Service" on
page 159).
2
3
4
5
Click Address Book tab > Individual.
Select Import from the Task drop down list.
Select Browse, and select the stored file.
Click Import > OK.
• Do not change the first row (model name, version, title field).
• Use comma(,) as a separator.
• When importing the address book data from a computer to the machine,
the existing address book data is deleted.
• Make sure to enter valid data. If you enter invalid data, unexpected errors
can occur. Refer to the below rules for entering valid data.
- Speed dial: A number is required for each address. You cannot use
duplicate numbers. Only numbers are allowed.
- User Name: This field is not mandatory. You can enter up to 64 byte
in UTF-8. <, “, >, \, / in not allowed.
Grouping addresses in the address book
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://123.123.123.123).
Click Login.
7. Setting up an Address Book
153
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Enter your ID and password and select a domain as you log in the
machine.
Click Login.
Click Address Book.
Editing address groups in the address Book
1
2
Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser.
(Example, http://123.123.123.123)
Click Groups.
Click Add Group.
Enter the group name to be added in Group Name.
Check Add individual(s) after this group is created.
If you do not want to add individual addresses to the group address you
made, skip this step. You can add individual addresses next time pressing
Group Details.
12
13
Click Apply.
14
Click the arrow in the middle. The selected addresses are added in Group
Address Book.
15
Click Apply.
Check the addresses you want to add to Group Address Book in
Individual Address Book.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service shows.
Click Login.
Enter the ID and password, and select a domain as you log in the
machine.
Click Login.
Click Address Book.
Click Groups.
Check the group address you want to edit and press Edit Group.
Change the group address information.
Click Apply.
Press Undo to delete the information you entered. If you press Cancel, the
Edit window closes.
7. Setting up an Address Book
154
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
Deleting address groups from the address book
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
5
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
6
7
8
9
10
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://123.123.123.123)
Checking address groups
You can see information about address groups and add or delete individual
addresses from the group in the Group Details window.
1
2
Open a web browser from your networked computer.
3
4
5
Press Enter or click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service page.
6
7
8
9
Click Login.
Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in the browser (for example,
http://123.123.123.123)
Click Login.
Enter the ID and password, and select a domain as you log in the
machine.
Click Login.
Click Login.
Enter the ID and password, and select a domain as you log in the
machine.
Click Address Book.
Click Groups.
Check the box for the groups you want to delete.
Click Delete Group.
Click OK when the confirmation window appears.
Click Address Book.
Click Groups.
Click the group address you want to see and click Group Details.
7. Setting up an Address Book
155
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
• You can add individual addresses directly. Check the addresses you want
to add to Group Address Book in Individual Address Book.
• You can delete individual addresses directly. Check the addresses you
want to delete and press Delete in Group Address Book.
7. Setting up an Address Book
156
8. Management Tools
This chapter introduces management tools provided to help you make full use of your machine.
This chapter includes:
• Accessing management tools
158
• SyncThru™ Web Service
159
• Easy Capture Manager
166
• Samsung AnyWeb Print
167
• Easy Eco Driver
168
• Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
169
• Using Samsung Easy Printer Manager
170
• Using Samsung Printer Status
173
• Using Samsung Printer Experience
175
• Using Box
181
Accessing management tools
Samsung provides a variety of management tools for Samsung printers.
1
2
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and powered on.
From the Start menu, select Programs or All Programs.
•
3
4
5
For Windows 8, from the Charms, select Search > Apps.
Find Samsung Printers.
Under Samsung Printers, you can see installed management tools.
Click the management tool you want to use.
• After installing the driver, for some management tools, you can access them directly from the Start menu > Programs or All Programs.
• For Windows 8, after installing the driver, for some management tools, you can access them directly from the Start screen by clicking on the corresponding tile.
8. Management Tools
158
SyncThru™ Web Service
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the network
environment through SyncThru™Web Service.
• Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for
SyncThru™ Web Service.
• Some menus may not appear on the display screen depending on the
settings or models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
1
What is SyncThru™Web Service?
If you have connected your machine to a network and set up TCP/IP network
parameters correctly, you can manage the machine via SyncThru™ Web Service.
Use SyncThru™ Web Service to:
•
View the machine’s device information and check its current status.
•
Change TCP/IP parameters and set up other network parameters.
•
Change the printer preference.
•
Set the email notifications advising of the machine’s status.
•
Get support for using the machine.
•
Upgrade machine software.
2
Required web browser
You need one of the following web browsers to use SyncThru™Web Service.
•
Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higher
•
Chrome 4.0 or higher
•
FireFox 3.0 or higher
•
Safari 3.0 or higher
3
Connecting to SyncThru™ Web Service
IPv4 supported web browser
1
Start a web browser, such as Internet Explorer®, that supports IPv4
addressing as a URL.
Enter the machine’s IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address
field and press the Enter key or click Go.
You can get the machine’s IP address from the machine report (see"Report"
on page 295).
2
Your machine’s SyncThru™ Web Service website opens.
8. Management Tools
159
SyncThru™ Web Service
IPv6 supported web browser
1
Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.
A log-in page appears.
1
Start a web browser, such as Internet Explorer®, that supports IPv6
addressing as a URL.
2
Select one of the IPv6 addresses (Stateless Address, Stateful Address,
Manual Address) from Network Configuration Report.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
You can get the machine’s IPv6 address from the machine report
(see"Report" on page 295).
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
3
2
Type in the ID and Password and select the Domain. Then click on
LOGIN.
Enter the IPv6 addresses (eg., http://[3ffe:10:88:194:213:77ff:fe82:75b]).
The address must be enclosed in '[ ]' brackets.
4
Your machine’s SyncThru™ Web Service website opens.
4
Logging into SyncThru™ Web Service
Before configuring options in SyncThru™ Web Service, you need to log-in as an
administrator. You can still use SyncThru™ Web Service without logging in, but
you will not have access to or view the Settings tab and the Security tab.
8. Management Tools
160
SyncThru™ Web Service
•
5
Information tab
This tab gives you general information about your machine. You can check
things, such as the machine’s status, supplies’ status, count information,
network information, and more. You can also print reports, such as
configuration page.
•
Active Alerts: You can check the current alerts in the machine. Use this
information to troubleshoot machine errors.
•
Supplies: You can check the supplies’ information. For toner cartridges and
imaging units, supplies’ status is displayed with a visual graph showing you
the amount of each supply left. Page counts are also available which can
help you predict when to change the supplies. This feature is also available
from the machine (see "Supplies Life" on page 295).
Print Information: You can print all the reports provided by your machine.
You can use these reports to help you maintain your machine. This feature
is also available in the machine (see "Report" on page 295).
6
Box tab
You can manage the Box. This feature is also available from the machine (see
"Using Box" on page 181).
Forward / Print / Send / Download
You can manage the folder and files in Forward, Print, Send, Download.
Usage Counters: You can check the billing information and usage counter
of the machine. This feature is also available from the machine (see
"Counter" on page 35).
•
Add: You can create Box in Print, Send, Download tab and Secured Box in
Print, Send tab.
•
Delete: You can delete Box and file in Forward, Print, Send, Download tab.
•
Current Settings: Shows the current settings of the machine and network.
•
Edit: You can edit Box and file name in Print, Send, Download tab.
•
Machine Information: Shows the current machine settings.
•
•
Network Information: Shows the current network settings. Use this page
as a reference and change the necessary settings needed for using the
network.
Browse: If you want to browse the Box, check the Box you want then click
Browse.
•
Task: You can copy and move the Box and files in Print, Send, Download
tab.
•
•
Security Information: Shows the current security settings of the machine
and network.
8. Management Tools
161
SyncThru™ Web Service
-
Scan & Send: You can set scan related settings. This feature is also
available from the machine (see "Understanding the Scan & Send
screen" on page 108).
You can manage the address book. This feature is also available from the
machine (see "Understanding the address screen" on page 143).
-
Box: You can set box related settings.This feature is also available from
the machine (see "Using Box" on page 181).
•
Individual: You can manage individual entries in the address book.
-
•
Group: You can manage group address books.
Address Book Setting: This address book contains contacts that are
available to all users. You can use the address book to make contacts
available to anyone who uses the machine.
-
E-mail Notification: When an error occurs or the consumables are
running out, the machine sends a notification to the administrator via email. You can set whether to use this feature or not. You can also select
which alerts to receive and when.
7
Address book tab
8
Settings tab
Settings tab has sub menus, Machine Settings and Network Settings. You
cannot view or access this tab if you do not log-in as an administrator (see
"Logging into SyncThru™ Web Service" on page 160).
•
Machine Settings: You can set machine settings.
Printer: You can set print related settings such as darkness or adjust the
background. This feature is also available from the machine (see "Print
Settings" on page 292).
General: You can set general machine information to use in the
network and set ethernet settings. This feature is also available from the
machine (see "Ethernet" on page 297).
-
Copy: You can set copy related settings such as darkness or adjusting
the background. This feature is also available from the machine (see
"Setting options" on page 97).
TCP/IPv4, TCP/IPv6, Raw TCP/IP, LPR, IPP,Telnet, WSD, SLP, UPNP, mDNS,
CIFS, SNMP, SNMPv1/v2, SNMPv3: You can set protocol settings.This
feature is also available from the machine
-
Outgoing Mail Server (SMTP): You can set server settings for outgoing
emails. If this setting is not configured, you cannot use scan to email
feature. Outgoing emails will be sent through SMTP server you set here.
This feature is also available from the machine (see "Network Protocol"
on page 299).
System: You can set machine related settings.
-
-
Network Settings: You can set up the network environment to use your
machine as a network machine. You can also set the settings from the
machine. Refer to the network setup chapter (see "Network Setup" on page
303).
-
-
-
•
Fax: You can set fax related settings such as fax number or redial times.
This feature is also available from the machine (see "Understanding the
fax screen" on page 126).
8. Management Tools
162
SyncThru™ Web Service
-
-
HTTP: You can allow or block users from accessing the SyncThru™ Web
Service. This feature is also available from the machine (see "Network
Protocol" on page 299).
•
Network Security: From the SyncThru™ Web Service, select the Security
tab > Network Security.
-
Interface Security: The Interface Security menu sets the basic policy for
connected interfaces. Only Print is enabled by default. For example, if
Scan is not enabled, then you cannot scan from a device connected via
Wi-Fi. You must select Scan or All Protocols in the menu to enable
scanning.
-
Digital Certificate: You can manage digital certificates. A digital
certificate is an electronic certificate that verifies the secure association
between communication nodes. You need to add the certificate for SSL
communication. This feature is also available from the machine (see
"Network Security" on page 300).
-
Secure Connection: You can enable or disable secure connection to
use more enhanced secure network channel. For secure
communication, using the Secure Connection feature is
recommended.
-
SNMPv3: You can set SNMPv3.
-
IP Security: You can set IP security settings.
-
802.1x (Ethernet): You can enable/disable 802.1x Security as well as
manage filtering rules. This feature is also available from the machine
(see "802.1x" on page 299).
Proxy: You can set proxy settings and enable authentication to connect
to licence server through http proxy server. These proxy settings are
provided currently only if the administrator wants to update an XOA
application’s license online through proxy server.
9
Security tab
The security tab has System Security, Network Security, User Access Control
and System Log. You cannot access this tab if you do not log-in as an
administrator (see "Log-in" on page 280).
•
System Security: From the SyncThru™ Web Service, select the Security tab
> System Security.
-
System Administrator: Enter the system administrator’s information.
The machine sends email notification to the email address set here. This
feature is also available from the machine (see "Contact Information" on
page 302).
-
Feature Management: You can enable/disable network features.
Check the features you want to enable and click Apply.
-
Information Hiding: You can enable/disable network features. Check
the features you want to enable and click Apply.
-
Restart Device: You can reboot your machine. Click the Restart Now
button to reboot.
8. Management Tools
163
SyncThru™ Web Service
-
IP/MAC Filtering: You can set filtering options for IP and MAC
addresses. If the administrator does not add a filtering rule for IPv4, IPv6,
and MAC addresses, nothing is filtered. If the administrator has added a
filtering rule, filtering will be applied to the entered IPv4, IPv6, and MAC
addresses.
▪
IPv4 Filtering: You can enable/disable IPv6 filtering as well as
manage filtering rules. This feature is also available from the
machine (see "Network filtering settings" on page 311).
▪
IPv6 Filtering: You can enable/disable IPv6 filtering as well as
manage filtering rules. This feature is also available from the
machine (see "Network filtering settings" on page 311).
▪
MAC Filtering: You can enable/disable Mac filtering as well as
manage filtering rules. This feature is also available from the
machine (see "Network filtering settings" on page 311).
•
User Access Control: You can restrict users from accessing the machine or
application. You can also give specific permission for user to only use certain
feature of the machine. For example, you can allow user A to only use print
feature. In this case, user A will not be able to scan, copy or fax with the
machine.
-
Authentication (Activating access control): You can choose the
authentication method for user authentication. Select a mode and click
on the Options button. This feature is also available from the machine
(see "Authentication" on page 289).
-
Authorization (Giving rights): You can give permissions to a user to
only use certain features of the machine.
-
Authority Management: You can give different rights to different
users. For example, you can allow user A to use all the machine’s
functions while giving user B only the right to print.
•
External Authentication Server: Set the servers for authentication.
-
Accounting: You can manage accounts.
•
802.1x: You can enable 802.1x authentication, which is a port-based
authentication. If this authentication is enabled, the machine is not allowed
to access through the protected side of the network until the machine is
authorized. Use this feature to protect your network. This feature is also
available from the machine (see "802.1x" on page 299).
-
User profile: You can store user information on the machine’s hard
drive. You can use this feature to manage the users using the machine.
You can also group the users and manage them as a group. You can add
up to 1,000 entries. User identified by user ID and password are allowed
to modify their password. They are allowed to view all of their profile
information. When it comes to the role, users are allowed to see only the
role they belong to but not its permissions.
8. Management Tools
164
SyncThru™ Web Service
•
System Log: You can keep logs of events that have happened in the
machine. The administrator can record and manage the machine usage
information by keeping the system log files. The system log files are stored
on the machine’s HDD (hard disk drive), and when it is full, it will erase old
data. Export and save the important audit data separately using the
exporting feature.
-
Log configuration: You can enable or disable keeping logs. You can
also backup log files by periods and transfer to a repository server.
Log Viewer: You can view, delete, and search log files.
•
Backup/Restore: You can backup the machine’s configurations and restore
the configuration when there is a problem with the machine. The saved
(backed up) files can also be used to configure other machines.
•
Contact Information: You can view contact information. To change the
information, (see "Contact Information" on page 302).
•
Link : You can view links to useful websites where you can:
-
view product information and get support (Samsung website).
-
download manuals and drivers.
-
order consumable supplies.
-
register your machine on-line.
10
Maintenance tab
This tab allows you to maintain your machine by upgrading firmware, managing
applications, and setting contact information for sending emails. You can also
connect to the Samsung website or download manuals and drivers by selecting
the Link menu.
•
Firmware Version: You can check the firmware version used in the
machine. Check the version and update it if necessary. This feature is also
available from the machine (see "Machine Details" on page 301).
•
Application Management: You can add or delete applications/license. If
you add an application, you need to activate the license of the installed
application. Some applications may not have a license. This feature is also
available from the machine (see "Application Management" on page 293)
8. Management Tools
165
Easy Capture Manager
• Available for Windows OS users only.
• This feature may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Software" on page 8).
Capture your screen and launch Easy Capture Manager by simply pressing the Print Screen key on the keyboard. Now you can easily print your captured screen as
captured or edited.
8. Management Tools
166
Samsung AnyWeb Print
• Available for Windows OS users only.
• This feature may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Software" on page 8).
This tool helps you screen-capture, preview, scrap, and print Windows Internet Explorer pages more easily, than when you use an ordinary program.
Download the software from the Samsung website then unpack and install it: (http://www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or Downloads).
8. Management Tools
167
Easy Eco Driver
Available for Windows OS users only (see "Software" on page 8).
With the Easy Eco Driver, you can apply Eco features to save paper and toner before printing.
Easy Eco Driver also allows you simple editing such as removing images and texts, and more. You can save frequently used settings as a preset.
How to use:
1 Open a document to print.
2 Open printing preference window (see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
3 From the Favorites tab, select Eco Printing Preview.
4 Click OK > Print in the window. A preview window appears.
5 Select the options you want to apply to the document.
You can see the preview of the applied features.
6 Click Print.
If you want to run Easy Eco Driver every time you print, check Start Easy Eco Driver before printing job checkbox in the Basic tab of the printing preference
window.
8. Management Tools
168
Using Samsung Easy Document Creator
Samsung Easy Document Creator is an application to help users scan, compile,
and save documents in multiple formats, including .epub format. These
documents can be shared via social networking sites or fax. Whether you’re a
student needing to organize research from the library or a stay-at-home mom
sharing scanned pictures from last year’s birthday party, Samsung Easy
Document Creator will provide you with the necessary tools.
The Samsung Easy Document Creator provides features mentioned below:
•
Image Scanning: Use for scanning single or multiple pictures.
•
Document Scanning: Use for scanning documents with text or text and
images.
•
Text Converting: Use for scanning documents that need to be saved in an
editable text format.
•
Book Scanning: Use for scanning books with the flatbed scanner.
•
SNS Upload: Provides an easy and quick way to upload scanned image or
existing images to a variety of social networking sites (SNS).
•
E-Book Conversion: Provides the ability to scan multiple documents asone
E-Book or convert existing files into an E-Book format.
•
Plug-in: Scan and fax directly from the Microsoft Office program.
Click the Help ( ) button from the window, and then click on any option
you want to know about.
8. Management Tools
169
Using Samsung Easy Printer Manager
• Available for Windows and Mac OS users only.
The screenshot may differ depending on operating system you are using.
• For Windows, Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher is the minimum
requirement for Samsung Easy Printer Manager.
Samsung Easy Printer Manager is an application that combines Samsung
machine settings into one location. Samsung Easy Printer Manager combines
device settings as well as printing environments, settings/actions and
launching. All of these features provide a gateway to conveniently use your
Samsung machine. Samsung Easy Printer Manager provides two different user
interfaces for the user to choose from: the basic user interface and the advanced
user interface. Switching between the two interfaces is easy: just click a button.
11
Understanding Samsung Easy Printer Manager
To open the program:
For Windows,
Select Start > Programs or All Programs > Samsung Printers > Samsung
Easy Printer Manager > Samsung Easy Printer Manager.
For Mac,
Printer list
1
The Printer List displays printers installed on your computer
and network printers added by network discovery (Windows
only).
Open the Applications folder > Samsung folder > Samsung Easy Printer
Manager.
The Samsung Easy Printer Manager interface is comprised of various basic
sections as described in the table that follows:
8. Management Tools
170
Using Samsung Easy Printer Manager
Quick links
Printer
This area gives you general information about your machine.
information You can check information, such as the machine’s model
name, IP address (or Port name), and machine status.
Displays Quick links to machine specific functions. This
section also includes links to applications in the advanced
settings.
4
You can view the online User’s Guide.
2
If you connect your machine to a network, the
SyncThru™ Web Service icon is enabled.
Troubleshooting button: This button opens the
Troubleshooting Guide when an error occurs. You
can directly open the necessary section in the user’s
guide.
5
Application Includes links for changing to the advanced
information settings(switching UI), refresh, preference setting, summary,
help, and about.
3
The
button is used to change the user interface to
the advanced settings user interface (see
"Advanced settings user interface overview" on page
172).
6
Contents
area
Displays information about the selected machine, remaining
toner level, and paper. The information will vary based on the
machine selected. Some machines do not have this feature.
Order
supplies
Click on the Order button from the supply ordering window.
You can order replacement toner cartridge(s) from online.
Select the Help menu or click the
button from the window and click on
any option you want to know about.
8. Management Tools
171
Using Samsung Easy Printer Manager
Alert Settings (Windows only)
12
Advanced settings user interface overview
This menu includes settings related to error alerting.
The advanced user interface is intended to be used by the person responsible
for managing the network and machines.
Some menus may not appear in the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
•
Printer Alert: Provides settings related to when alerts will be received.
•
Email Alert: Provides options relating to receiving alerts via email.
•
Alert History: Provides a history of device and toner related alerts.
Job Accounting
Device Settings
You can configure various machine settings such as machine setup, paper,
layout, emulation, network, and print information.
Provides querying of quota information of the specified job accounting user.
This quota information can be created and applied to devices by job accounting
software such as SyncThru™ or CounThru™ admin software.
Scan to PC Settings
This menu includes settings to create or delete scan to PC profiles.
•
Scan Activation: Determines whether or not scanning is enabled on the
device.
•
Basic tab: Contains settings related general scan and device settings.
•
Image tab: Contains settings related to image altering.
8. Management Tools
172
Using Samsung Printer Status
The Samsung Printer Status is a program that monitors and informs you of the
machine status.
• The Samsung Printer Status window and its contents shown in this user’s
guide may differ depending on the machine or operating system in use.
Icon
Mean
Description
Normal
The machine is in ready mode and experiencing no
errors or warnings.
Warning
The machine is in a state where an error might
occur in the future. For example, it might be in
toner low status, which may lead to toner empty
status.
Error
The machine has at least one error.
• Check the operating system(s) that are compatible with your machine
(see "System requirements" on page 253).
• Available for Windows OS users only.
13
Samsung Printer Status overview
If an error occurs while operating, you can check the error from the Samsung
Printer Status. Samsung Printer Status is installed automatically when you install
the machine software.
You can also launch Samsung Printer Status manually. Go to the Printing
Preferences, click the Basic tab > Printer Status button.
These icons appear on the Windows task bar:
8. Management Tools
173
Using Samsung Printer Status
User’s Guide
This button opens the Troubleshooting Guide
when an error occurs. You can directly open the
troubleshooting section in the user’s guide.
1
Supplies
Information
2
Option
3
You can view the percentage of toner remaining in
each toner cartridge. The machine and the number of
toner cartridge(s) shown in the above window may
differ depending on the machine in use. Some
machines do not have this feature.
You can set printing job alert related settings.
Order Supplies
You can order replacement toner cartridge(s) from
online.
Cancel Print
• Cancel Print : If print job is waiting in the print
queue or printer, cancel all user's print jobs in the
print queue or the printer.
4
or
5
You can view the online User’s Guide.
Close
• Close : Depending on the status of the machine or
the supported functions, the Close button may
appear to close the status window.
8. Management Tools
174
Using Samsung Printer Experience
Samsung Printer Experience is a Samsung application that combines
Samsung machine settings and machine management into one location. You
can set device settings, order supplies, open troubleshooting guides, visit
Samsung’s website, and check connected machine information. This application
will be automatically downloaded from the Windows Store if the machine is
connected to a computer with an Internet connection.
The screenshot may differ depending on the model you are using.
Available for Windows 8 users only.
14
Understanding the Samsung Printer Experience
To open the application,
From the Start screen, select the Samsung Printer Experience (
) tile.
The Samsung Printer Experience interface comprises various useful features as
described in the following table:
1
Printer
Information
This area gives you general information about your
machine. You can check information, such as the
machine’s status, location, IP address, and remaining
toner level.
8. Management Tools
175
Using Samsung Printer Experience
15
2
User’s Guide
You can view the online User’s Guide. You need to be
connected to the Internet to use this feature.
This button opens the Troubleshooting Guide
when an error occurs. You can directly open the
troubleshooting section in the user’s guide.
Adding/Deleting Printers
If you do not have any printer added to the Samsung Printer Experience, or if
you want to add/delete a printer, follow the instructions below.
You can only add/delete network connected printers.
Order Supplies
3
4
Visit Samsung
Printer Settings
5
6
Device List &
Latest Scanned
Image
Click on this button to order replacement toner
cartridges online. You need to be connected to the
Internet to use this feature.
Links to Samsung printer website. You need to be
connected to the Internet to use this feature.
You can configure various machine settings such as
machine setup, paper, layout, emulation, networking,
and print information through SyncThru™ Web Service.
Your machine needs to be connected to a network. This
button will be disabled if your machine is connected via
USB cable.
The scan list displays devices that supports Samsung
Printer Experience. Under the device, you can see the
latest scanned images. Your machine needs to be
connected to a network to scan from here. This section is
for the users with multi-functional printers.
Adding a printer
1
From the Charms, select Settings.
Or, right-click the Samsung Printer Experience page and select
Settings.
2
3
Select Add Printer
Select the printer you want to add.
You can see the added printer.
If you see
mark, you can also click
mark to add printers.
8. Management Tools
176
Using Samsung Printer Experience
Deleting a printer
1
From the Charms, select Settings.
4
5
Select the printer settings, such as the number of copies and orientation.
Click the Print button to start the print job.
Or, right-click the Samsung Printer Experience page and select
Settings.
2
3
4
Select Remove Printer.
Select the printer you want to delete.
Click Yes.
You can see that the selected printer is removed from the screen.
16
Printing from Windows 8
This section explains common printing tasks from the Start screen.
Basic printing
1
2
3
Open the document to print.
From the Charms, select Devices.
Select your printer from the list
8. Management Tools
177
Using Samsung Printer Experience
Cancelling a print job
Basic tab
If the printing job is waiting in the print queue or print spooler, cancel the job as
follows:
•
You can access this window by simply double-clicking the machine icon
(
•
) in the Windows task bar.
You can also cancel the current job by pressing
(Stop) button on the
control panel.
Opening more settings
The screen may appear somewhat different depending on the model or
options.
You can set up more printing parameters.
Basic
This option allows you to choose the basic printing settings such as copies,
orientation, and document type.
Eco settings
1
2
3
4
Open the document you want to print.
This option allows you to choose multiple pages per side to save media.
From the Charms, select Devices.
Select your printer from the list
Click More settings.
8. Management Tools
178
Using Samsung Printer Experience
Advanced tab
Security tab
Some features may not be available depending on the model or options. If
this tab is not shown or disabled, it means that this features are not
supported.
Paper settings
This option allows you to set the basic paper handling specifications.
Layout settings
This option allows you to set the various ways to layout your documents.
Job Accounting
This option allows you to print with the given permission.
Confidential Printing
This option is used for printing confidential documents. You need to enter a
password to print using it.
8. Management Tools
179
Using Samsung Printer Experience
Using the sharing feature
Scanning from Samsung Printer Experience
Samsung Printer Experience allows you to print from other applications
installed on the computer using the sharing feature.
The most frequently used printing menus are displayed for quick scanning.
This feature is only available for printing jpeg, bmp, tiff, gif, and png file
formats.
1
2
3
4
Select the content you want to print from other application.
From the Charms, select Share > Samsung Printer Experience.
Select the printer settings, such as the number of copies and orientation.
Click the Print button to start the print job.
1
Place a single document face down on the document glass, or load the
documents face up into the document feeder.
2
3
4
Click the Samsung Printer Experience tile on the Start screen.
5
6
Click Prescan (
7
Click Scan (
Click Scan (
).
Set up the scanning parameters such as image type, document size, and
resolution.
) to check the image.
Adjust the prescanned image with scanning operation functions such as
rotate and mirror.
17
Scanning from Windows 8
This section is for the users with multi-functional printers.
)and save the image.
• When you place the originals in the DSDF, Prescan (
) is not
available.
• You can skip step 5, if the Prescan option is selected.
Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital files that
can be stored on your computer.
8. Management Tools
180
Using Box
18
19
Understanding the Box screen
Command keys
Documents and images printed, scanned, downloaded and sent from
computers can be stored in the Box. The Box is located on your machine’s hard
disk drive (HDD). It means the documents are stored on the HDD. You can create
a password for a certain Stored Document, so unauthorized users cannot access
it. Also, you can print stored documents by using a variety of printing features
and send the documents to several destination such as email, server or fax. You
can set a Stored Document and Stored Document feature with SyncThru™ Web
Service.
• If important data is stored in the Box, we recommend you to backup the
data regularly. Samsung disclaims all responsibility for damage or loss of
data caused by misuse or failure of the machine.
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
then click on any option you want to know about.
When you selected files, shows below meus.
•
(Print) : Print files directly.
•
(Send) : Send files to Fax, Email, Server, Box, or USB.
•
(Delete) : Delete folders and files.
Button
Name
Description
Quick Menu
Open the quick menu.
Search
Search for a desired menu or app.
View Mode
Select the view type.
My Program
Show my program list.
(quick menu) and
8. Management Tools
181
Using Box
Button
Name
Description
Sub menu
Open the sub menu.
(Action overflow) • Select All : Select all folders and files.
• Print Options : Set options for printing.
Storage
Button
Name
Forward
Description
Manage the forward data.
• Create folder : Create a folder.
• Rename : Rename a folder or a file.
To use this feature, you may need to log-in
as an administrator (see "Log-in" on page
280).
• Delete : Delete folders and files.
• Copy : Copy folders and files.
• Move : Move folders or files to other storage.
• Clear Browsing Info : Clear browsing
information.
Print
Manage the stored print data.
• Detail : View the detail information about a
folder or a file.
Send
Manage the stored send data.
Download
Manage the stored download data.
USB
Use a USB Drive device.
• Filing Policy : Select a filing policy.
• Format : Formatting files or data.
8. Management Tools
182
Using Box
Job progress
Creating a private folder
This menu appears whenever the machine is processing a job.
•
Detail : Tap this button to see the status, folder path, and time of the job.
•
Preview Area : Allows you to see a preview of the document being saved.
The image in the Preview area indicates the current send settings, such as
the orientation and size of the file.
This function is not available in Download and USB storage.
•
Public: All users can access to the files.
•
Private: Set up the password to prevent unauthorized person from
accessing.
20
Using Box
To use the Box feature, tap Box from the home screen or Apps.
Storage allows you to store the scanned data on HDD (your machine's hard disk
drive) in your machine. The stored data can be sent to different destinations like
Fax, Email, Server, Box, or USB.
1
Select the type of Storage (Print or Send) in which you want to create
the folder.
2
3
4
Tap
> Create folder.
Input the folder name and select Set as Private, and then tap OK.
the appropriate information in the ID, Password, Confirm Password
fields, and then tap OK.
Using multi check
This function is not available in Print and Send storage.
Touch and hold a folder or file, then change the multi check mode.
8. Management Tools
183
9. Troubleshooting
This chapter gives helpful information for what to do if you encounter an error.
This chapter includes:
• Redistributing toner
185
• Replacing the toner cartridge
187
• Replacing the imaging unit
189
• Tips for avoiding paper jams
191
• Clearing jams
192
• Understanding display messages
208
• Power and cable connecting problems
213
• Solving other problems
214
If you cannot solve problems using this chapter, contact your administrator or service center.
You can see the contact information from Settings > System > Contact Information. This
information is configured by the machine’s administrator.
Redistributing toner
When the toner cartridge is near the end of its life:
•
White streaks or light printing occurs and/or density variation side to side.
•
The Status LED blinks red. The toner-related message saying that the toner is low may appear on the display.
•
The computer’s Samsung Printing Status program window appears on the computer telling you which cartridge is low on toner (see "Using Samsung Printer
Status" on page 173).
If this happens, you can temporarily improve print quality by redistributing the remaining toner in the cartridge. In some cases, white streaks or light printing will still
occur even after you have redistributed the toner.
IlIllustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• To prevent damage to the toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes. Cover it with a piece of paper, if necessary.
• Do not touch the green area of the toner cartridge. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area.
• Do not use sharp objects such as a knife or scissors to open the toner cartridge package. They might scratch the drum of the cartridge.
• If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.
9. Troubleshooting
185
Redistributing toner
9. Troubleshooting
186
Replacing the toner cartridge
A toner cartridge has almost reached its estimated cartridge life:
•
The status LED and the toner-related message on the display indicate when the toner cartridge should be replaced.
•
The computer's Samsung Printing Status Program window appears on the computer telling you cartridge is empty on toner (see "Using Samsung Printer Status"
on page 173).
Check the Product Code on top of the toner cartridge before ordering and installing to your machine (see "Available consumables" on page 234).
• Shake the toner cartridge thoroughly, it will increase the initial print quality.
• Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• To prevent damage to the toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes. Cover it with a piece of paper, if necessary.
• Do not touch the green area of the toner cartridge. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area.
• Do not use sharp objects such as a knife or scissors to open the toner cartridge package. They might scratch the drum of the cartridge.
• If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.
9. Troubleshooting
187
Replacing the toner cartridge
1
Toner cartridge
9. Troubleshooting
188
Replacing the imaging unit
2
Imaging unit
9. Troubleshooting
189
Replacing the imaging unit
9. Troubleshooting
190
Tips for avoiding paper jams
By selecting the correct media types, most paper jams can be avoided. When a
paper jam occurs, refer to the next guidelines.
•
Ensure that the adjustable guides are positioned correctly (see "Loading
paper in the tray" on page 50).
Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper
capacity mark on the inside of the tray.
•
Do not remove paper from the tray while your machine is printing.
•
Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading.
•
Do not use creased, damp, or highly curled paper.
•
Do not mix paper types in a tray.
•
Use only recommended print media (see "Print media specifications" on
page 249).
9. Troubleshooting
191
Clearing jams
To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out slowly and gently.
3
In tray1
Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page 21).
9. Troubleshooting
192
Clearing jams
4
In optional tray
• Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• This troubleshooting may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Variety feature" on page 10).
9. Troubleshooting
193
Clearing jams
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
9. Troubleshooting
194
Clearing jams
5
In the multi-purpose tray
9. Troubleshooting
195
Clearing jams
6
Inside the machine
The Fuser area is HOT, please wait until device cools down before accessing this area. Turn power off to cool the machine down. Take care when removing paper
from the machine.
Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page 21).
9. Troubleshooting
196
Clearing jams
9. Troubleshooting
197
Clearing jams
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
9. Troubleshooting
198
Clearing jams
7
In the exit area
The Fuser area is HOT, please wait until device cools down before accessing this area. Turn power off to cool the machine down. Take care when removing paper
from the machine.
9. Troubleshooting
199
Clearing jams
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
9. Troubleshooting
200
Clearing jams
8
In the duplex unit area
9. Troubleshooting
201
Clearing jams
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
9. Troubleshooting
202
Clearing jams
9
Clearing original document jams
To prevent document jams, use the scanner glass for thick, thin or mixed paper originals.
To avoid tearing the document, remove the jammed document slowly and carefully.
9. Troubleshooting
203
Clearing jams
Original paper jam in front of scanner
• Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• This troubleshooting may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Variety feature" on page 10).
9. Troubleshooting
204
Clearing jams
Original paper jam inside of scanner
• Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• This troubleshooting may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Variety feature" on page 10).
9. Troubleshooting
205
Clearing jams
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to next step:
9. Troubleshooting
206
Clearing jams
Original paper jam in exit area of scanner
• Illustrations in this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on the model and options installed. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page
21).
• This troubleshooting may not be available depending on model or optional goods (see "Front view" on page 21).
9. Troubleshooting
207
Understanding display messages
Messages appear on the display screen to indicate the machine’s status or
errors. Some error messages are shown with graphics to help you troubleshoot
problem. Refer to the tables below to understand the messages and their
meaning, and correct the problem, if necessary. Messages and their
explanations are listed in alphabetical order.
Message
Meaning
End of life. Replace with
new imaging unit
The indicated imaging
unit has reached its
estimated imaging
unit lifea.
• If a message is not in the table, reboot the power and try the printing job
again. If the problem persists, call for service.
End of life. Replace with
new toner cartridge
• When you call for service, provide the service representative with the
contents of display message.
The indicated toner
cartridge has reached
its estimated cartridge
lifea.
• Some messages may not appear in the display depending on options or
models.
Engine System Failure
[error number]. Turn off
then on.
• [tray number] indicates the tray number.
• [media type] indicates the media type.
Message
Meaning
Did not supply enough
toner. Remove seal tape
of toner cartridge or
shake it. Call for service if
the problem persists
The machine cannot
detect a toner
cartridge. Or the seal
tape was not removed
from the toner
cartridge.
Remove the sealing tape
from the toner cartridge.
Refer to Quick Install
Guide.
Replace the toner
cartridge with a Samsunggenuine toner cartridgeb
(see "Replacing the toner
cartridge" on page 187).
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Fan Failure: [error
number]. Turn off then
on. Call for service if the
problem persists.
There is a problem in
the fan system.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Front door is open. Close
it.
The door is not
securely latched.
Close the door until it locks
into place.
Engine Failure [error
number].
Suggested solutions
Replace the imaging unit
with a Samsung-genuine
imaging unit (see
"Replacing the imaging
unit" on page 189).
There is a problem in
the engine system.
• [media size] indicates the paper size.
• [error number] indicates the error number.
Suggested solutions
Call for service if the
problem persists.
9. Troubleshooting
208
Understanding display messages
Message
Fuser Failure [error
number]. Turn off then
on.
Meaning
There is a problem in
the fuser unit.
Fuser Unit Failure [error
number]. Turn off then
on.
Imaging Unit Failure:
[error number]. Install
imaging unit again
Imaging unit Failure:
[error number]. Call for
service
Imaging unit is not
compatible. Check users
guide
Input System Failure
[error number]:Check
[tray number]
connection.
The imaging unit is not
installed.
There is a problem in
the imaging unit.
The imaging unit you
have installed is not for
your machine.
There is a problem in
the tray
Suggested solutions
Message
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Input System Failure
[error number]:Pull [tray
number] out and insert
it.
There is a problem in
the tray.
Open and close the tray. If
the problem persists, call
for service.
Lamp Failure: [error
number]. Open the door,
then close it. Call for
service if the problem
persists
There is a problem in
the lamp.
Open the door, then close
it. If the problem persists,
call for service.
Load [tray number] with
[Letter], [Plain] paper
Thepapersize specified
in the printer
properties does not
match the paper you
are loading.
Load the correct paper in
the tray.
LSU Failure: [error
number]. Please turn off
then on
There is a problem in
the LSU.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Install the imaging unit. If
it is already installed, try to
reinstall the imaging unit.
If the problem persists, call
for service.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Install a Samsung-genuine
imaging unit, designed for
your machine (see
"Available consumables"
on page 234).
Open and close the tray. If
the problem persists, call
for service.
Meaning
LSU Failure: [error
number]. Turn off then
on. Call for service if the
problem persists.
Motor Failure: [error
number]. Turn off then
on. Call for service if the
problem persists.
Suggested solutions
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
There is a problem in
the motor system.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
9. Troubleshooting
209
Understanding display messages
Message
Original paper jam in
front of the scanner
Meaning
Suggested solutions
The originals are
jammed in Dual scan
document feeder.
Clear the jam (see
"Original paper jam in
front of scanner" on page
204).
Original paper jam inside The originals are
of the scanner
jammed in Dual scan
document feeder.
Clear the jam (see
"Original paper jam inside
of scanner" on page 205).
Paper in output bin is
full. Remove printed
paper
The output tray is full.
Paper is empty in [tray
number]. Load paper.
Message
Meaning
Suggested solutions
Paper Jam in exit area.
Paper has jammed in
the exit area.
Clear the jam (see "In the
exit area" on page 199).
Paper Jam inside of
machine
Paper has jammed
inside of the machine.
Clear the jam (see "In
tray1" on page 192 or "In
optional tray" on page 193
or "Inside the machine" on
page 196).
Remove printouts from
the output tray, the
machine resumes printing.
Paper jam in tray 1
Paper has jammed in
the feeding area of the
tray.
Clear the jam (see "In
tray1" on page 192).
There is no paper in the
tray.
Load paper in the tray.
Paper jam in Tray 2
Paper is empty in tray
MP. Load paper.
There is no paper in the
multi-purpose tray.
Load paper in the multipurpose tray.
Paper is low in [tray
number]. Load paper.
Running out of paper
in the tray.
Load paper in the tray.
Paper Jam at the bottom
of duplex path
Paper has jammed
Clear the jam (see "In the
during duplex printing. duplex unit area" on page
201).
Paper Jam inside of
duplex path
Paper Jam at the top of
duplex path
Clear the jam (see "In
optional tray" on page
193).
Prepare new imaging
unit
The estimated lifea of
the imaging unit is
close.
Prepare a new imaging
unit for a replacement (see
"Replacing the imaging
unit" on page 189).
Prepare new toner
cartridge
The estimated
Prepare a new cartridge
for a replacement. You
may temporarily increase
the printing quality by
redistributing the toner
(see "Redistributing toner"
on page 185).
cartridge lifea of toner
is close.
9. Troubleshooting
210
Understanding display messages
Message
Meaning
Suggested solutions
Rear door is open. Close
the door
The door is not
securely latched.
Close the door until it locks
into place.
Replace with new toner
cartridge
The indicated toner
cartridge has almost
reached its estimated
Replace the toner
cartridge for the best print
quality when this message
appears. Using a cartridge
beyond this stage can
result in printing quality
issues (see "Replacing the
toner cartridge" on page
187).
cartridge lifea.
If the machine stops
printing, replace the toner
cartridge (see "Replacing
the toner cartridge" on
page 187).
The indicated imaging
unit has almost
reached its estimated
Replace with new
imaging unit
imaging unit lifea.
Replace the imaging unit
for the best print quality
when this message
appears. Using a imaging
unit beyond this stage can
result in printing quality
issues (see "Replacing the
imaging unit" on page
189).
Message
Meaning
Suggested solutions
Scanner locked or
another problem
occurred.
The CCD (Charged
Couple Device) lock
has been locked.
Unlock the CCD lock. Or
turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Sensor Failure: [error
number]. Turn off then
on. Call for service if the
problem persists.
There is a problem in
the sensor system.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Shake toner cartridge
and then install. Replace
toner cartridge if the
problem persists
Small amount of toner
is left in the indicated
cartridge.
You may temporarily
increase the printing
quality by redistributing
the toner (see
"Redistributing toner" on
page 185).
Shake toner cartridge
and then install. Replace
toner cartridge if the
problem persists
Small amount of toner
is left in the indicated
cartridge.
You may temporarily
increase the printing
quality by redistributing
the toner (see
"Redistributing toner" on
page 185). If the problem
persists, call for service.
The room temperature is
not suitable for this set
use. Please adjust room
temperature
The machine is in a
room with improper
room temperature.
Please adjust room
temperature (see
"Specifications" on page
247).
9. Troubleshooting
211
Understanding display messages
Message
Meaning
Suggested solutions
Toner Cartridge Failure:
[error number]. Call for
service
There is a problem in
the toner cartridge.
Turn the machine off and
back on again. If the
problem persists, call for
service.
Toner cartridge is not
installed. Install the
cartridge
A toner cartridge is not
installed.
Reinstall the toner
cartridge.
Toner cartridge is not
compatible. Check users
guide
The imaging unit you
have installed is not for
your machine.
Install a Samsung-genuine
imaging unit, designed for
your machine (see
"Available consumables"
on page 234).
Top door of scanner is
open
The Dual scan
document feeder
cover is not securely
latched.
Close the cover until it
locks into place.
[tray number] cassette is
pulled out. Insert insert it
properly.
The tray is not securely
latched.
Close the tray until it locks
into place.
a. Estimated cartridge life means the expected or estimated cartridge, which indicates the
average capacity of print-outs and is designed pursuant to ISO/IEC 19752. The number of
pages may be affected by the percentage of image area, operating environment, printing
interval, media type and media size.
b. When the toner cartridge has reached its end of life, the machine will stop printing. In this
case, you can choose to stop or continue printing from the SyncThru™Web Service. (Settings
> Machine Settings > System > Setup > Supplies Management > Toner Cartridge Stop)
or Samsung Easy Printer Manager (Device Settings > System > Supplies Management >
Toner Cartridge Stop). Turning off this option and continuing to print may damage the
device's system.
9. Troubleshooting
212
Power and cable connecting problems
Condition
The machine is not receiving power,
or the connection cable between the
computer and the machine is not
connected properly.
Suggested solutions
• Connect the machine to the electricity supply first. If the machine has a
(Power / Wake Up) button on the control,
press it.
• Disconnect the machine’s cable and reconnect it.
9. Troubleshooting
213
Solving other problems
The following chart lists some trouble conditions that may occur and the
recommended solutions. Follow the suggested solutions until the problem is
corrected. If the problem persists, contact a service representative.
11
Paper feeding problems
Other problems include:
Condition
Suggested solutions
•
See "Display screen problem" on page 214.
See "Paper feeding problems" on page 214.
Paper jams during
printing.
Clear the paper jam (see "Clearing jams" on page 192).
•
•
See "Printing problems" on page 215.
Paper sticks together.
•
See "Printing quality problems" on page 218.
• Check the maximum paper capacity of the tray (see
"Print media specifications" on page 249).
•
See "Copying problems" on page 223.
•
See "Scanning problems" on page 224.
•
See "Faxing problems" on page 225.
•
See "Operating system problems" on page 227.
• Make sure that you are using the correct type of
paper (see "Print media specifications" on page
249).
• Remove paper from the tray and flex or fan the
paper.
• Humid conditions may cause some paper to stick
together. Try a fresh ream of paper.
Multiple sheets of
paper do not feed.
10
Display screen problem
• Different types of paper may be stacked in the tray.
Load paper of only one type, size, and weight.
• If multiple sheets have caused a paper jam, clear
the paper jam (see "Clearing jams" on page 192).
Condition
The display screen does
not show anything.
Suggested solutions
• Adjusts the brightness of the display screen.
• Turn the machine off and back on again. If the
problem persists, call for service.
9. Troubleshooting
214
Solving other problems
12
Condition
Paper does not feed
into the machine.
Suggested solutions
• Paper has not been loaded correctly. Remove
paper from the tray and reload it correctly.
• There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess
paper from the tray.
• The paper is too thick. Use only paper that meets
the specifications required by the machine (see
"Print media specifications" on page 249).
• If an original does not feed into the machine, the
DSDF rubber pad may require to be replaced.
Contact a service representative.
The paper keeps
jamming.
• There is too much paper in the tray. Remove excess
paper from the tray. If you are printing on special
materials, use the multi-purpose tray.
• An incorrect type of paper is being used. Use only
paper that meets the specifications required by the
machine (see "Print media specifications" on page
249).
• There may be debris inside the machine. Open the
front door and remove any debris.
• If an original does not feed into the machine, the
DSDF rubber pad may need to be replaced.
Contact a service representative.
Envelopes skew or fail
to feed correctly.
Printing problems
• Remove any obstructions from inside the machine.
Ensure that the paper guides are against both sides of
the envelopes.
Condition
The machine
does not print.
Possible cause
Suggested solutions
The machine is not
receiving power.
Check the power cord connections.
Check the power switch and the power
source.
The machine is not
selected as the default
machine.
Select your machine as your default
machine in your Windows.
Check the machine for the following:
•
The front door is not closed. Close the front door.
•
Paper is jammed. Clear the paper jam (see "Clearing jams" on
page 192).
•
No paper is loaded. Load paper (see "Loading paper in the tray"
on page 50).
•
The toner cartridge or the imaging unit is not installed. Install
the toner cartridge or imaging unit.
If a system error occurs, contact your service representative.
The connection cable
between the computer
and the machine is not
connected properly.
Disconnect the machine cable and
reconnect it.
The connection cable
between the computer
and the machine is
defective.
If possible, attach the cable to another
computer that is working properly and
print a job. You can also try using a
different machine cable.
9. Troubleshooting
215
Solving other problems
Condition
The machine
does not print.
The machine
selects print
materials from
the wrong
paper source.
Possible cause
The port setting is
incorrect.
Suggested solutions
Check the Windows printer setting to
make sure that the print job is sent to
the correct port. If the computer has
more than one port, make sure that
the machine is attached to the correct
one.
The machine may be
configured incorrectly.
Check the Printing Preferences to
ensure that all of the print settings are
correct (see "Opening printing
preferences" on page 66).
The printer driver may be
incorrectly installed.
Repair the machine software.
The machine is
malfunctioning.
Check the display message on the
control panel to see if the machine is
indicating a system error. Contact a
service representative.
The document size is so
big that the hard disk
space of the computer is
insufficient to access the
print job.
If printing GUI, make more hard disk
space available for your print and try
printing the document again.
The paper option that
was selected in the
Printing Preferences
may be incorrect.
For many software applications, the
paper source selection is found under
the Paper tab within the Printing
Preferences. Select the correct paper
source. See the printer driver help
screen (see "Opening printing
preferences" on page 66).
Condition
Possible cause
Suggested solutions
A print job is
extremely
slow.
The job may be very
complex.
Reduce the complexity of the page or
try adjusting the print quality settings.
Half the page is
blank.
The page orientation
setting may be incorrect.
Change the page orientation in your
application. See the printer driver help
screen.
The paper size and the
paper size settings do
not match.
Ensure that the paper size in the
printer driver settings matches the
paper in the tray. Or, ensure that the
paper size in the printer driver settings
matches the paper selection in the
software application settings you use.
9. Troubleshooting
216
Solving other problems
Condition
The machine
prints, but the
text is wrong,
garbled, or
incomplete.
Possible cause
The machine cable is
loose or defective.
The wrong printer driver
was selected.
Pages print,
but they are
blank.
Suggested solutions
Condition
Possible cause
Suggested solutions
Disconnect the machine cable and
reconnect. Try a print job that you
have already printed successfully. If
possible, attach the cable and the
machine to another computer that you
know works and try a print job. Finally,
try a new machine cable.
The machine
does not print
PDF file
correctly. Some
parts of
graphics, text,
or illustrations
are missing.
Incompatibility between
the PDF file and the
Acrobat products.
Printing the PDF file as an image may
enable the file to print. Turn on Print
As Image from the Acrobat printing
options.
If the PDF file do not
include the font or do
have the object which is
set on Interactive mode.
Try printing a job from Printer Driver.
The print
quality of
photos is not
good. Images
are not clear.
The resolution of the
photo is very low.
Reduce the photo size. If you increase
the photo size in the software
application, the resolution will be
reduced.
Before
printing, the
machine emits
vapor near the
output tray.
Using damp paper can
cause vapor during
printing.
This is not a problem. Just keep
printing. Try a fresh ream of paper.
The machine
does not print
special- sized
paper, such as
billing paper.
Paper size and paper size
setting do not match.
Set the correct paper size in the
Custom Paper List in the Paper tab in
the Printing Preferences (see "Paper
Options" on page 68).
Your machine
has an odd
smell during
initial use.
The oil used to protect
the fuser is evaporating.
After printing about 100 color pages,
there will be no more smell. It is a
temporary issue.
Check the application’s printer
selection menu to ensure that your
machine is selected.
The software application
is malfunctioning.
Try printing a job from another
application.
The operating system is
malfunctioning.
Exit Windows and reboot the
computer. Turn the machine off and
back on again.
If you are in a DOS
environment, the font
setting for your machine
may be set incorrectly.
Change the language setting.
The toner cartridge is
defective or out of toner.
Redistribute the toner, if necessary. If
necessary, replace the toner cartridge.
The file may have blank
pages.
Check the file to ensure that it does not
contain blank pages.
Some parts, such as the
controller or the board,
may be defective.
Contact a service representative.
9. Troubleshooting
217
Solving other problems
13
Printing quality problems
If the inside of the machine is dirty or paper has been loaded improperly, there
might be a reduction in print quality. See the table below to clear the problem.
Condition
Light or faded
print
Condition
Suggested Solutions
The top half of
the paper is
printed lighter
than the rest of
the paper
The toner might not adhere properly to this type of paper.
Toner specks
• The paper may not meet specifications; for example, the
paper may be too moist or rough (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
• Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing
Preferences, click the Paper tab, and set the paper type to
Recycled (see "Opening printing preferences" on page
66).
Suggested Solutions
• If a vertical white streak or faded area appears on the page,
the toner supply is low. You may be able to temporarily
extend the toner cartridge life. If this does not improve the
print quality, install a new toner cartridge.
• The color tone might not be adjusted. Adjust the color
tone.
• The paper may not meet paper specifications; for example,
the paper may be too moist or rough (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
• If the entire page is light, the print resolution setting is too
low or the toner save mode is on. Adjust the print
resolution and turn the toner save mode off. See the help
screen of the printer driver.
• A combination of faded or smeared defects may indicate
that the toner cartridge needs cleaning. Contact a service
representative.
• The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the inside of your
machine. Contact a service representative.
• The paper path may need cleaning. Contact a service
representative.
• Check the location of the machine. If the area is not wellventilated, this problem may occur.
• The surface of the LSU part inside the machine may be
dirty. Clean the LSU, contact a service representative.
9. Troubleshooting
218
Solving other problems
Condition
Dropouts
Suggested Solutions
If faded areas, generally rounded, occur randomly on the
page:
Condition
Vertical lines
If white vertical streaks appear on the page:
• The moisture content of the paper is uneven or the paper
has moist spots on its surface. Try a different brand of
paper (see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
• The surface of the LSU part inside the machine may be
dirty. Cleaning the inside or contact a service
representative.
• The paper lot is bad. The manufacturing processes can
cause some areas to reject toner. Try a different kind or
brand of paper.
If vertical streaks appear on the page:
• The surface of the scanner glass and its white sheet may be
dirty. Cleaning the inside or contact a service
representative.
• Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing
Preferences, click Paper tab, and set type to thick paper
(see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
White Spots
If white spots appear on the page:
• The paper is too rough and a lot of dirt from a paper falls to
the inner devices within the machine, so the transfer roller
may be dirty. Clean the inside of your machine. Cleaning
the inside or contact a service representative.
If black vertical streaks appear on the page:
• The drum inside the printer has probably been scratched.
Remove the imaging unit and install a new one. Contact a
service representative.
• A single sheet of paper may be defective. Try reprinting
the job.
• If these steps do not correct the problem, contact a service
representative.
Suggested Solutions
Color or Black
background
If the amount of background shading becomes unacceptable:
• Change the image transfer belt if it has reached its lifespan.
Contact a service representative.
• Check the environmental conditions: very dry conditions
(low humidity) or a high level of humidity (higher than
80% RH) can increase the amount of background shading.
• Remove the old toner cartridge and install a new one.
• The paper path may need cleaning. Cleaning the inside or
contact a service representative.
9. Troubleshooting
219
Solving other problems
Condition
Toner smear
Suggested Solutions
If toner smears on the page:
• Clean the inside of the machine. Cleaning the inside or
contact a service representative.
Condition
Background
scatter
• Remove the imaging unit and install a new one. Contact a
service representative.
• If background scatter occurs on an envelope, change the
printing layout to avoid printing over areas that have
overlapping seams on the reverse side. Printing on seams
can cause problems.
• Change the image transfer belt if it has reached its lifespan.
Contact a service representative.
If marks repeatedly appear on the printed side of the page at
even intervals:
• The imaging unit may be damaged. If a repetitive mark
occurs on the page, run a cleaning sheet through several
times to clean the imaging unit. Cleaning the inside. If you
still have the same problems, remove the imaging unit and
install a new one. Contact a service representative.
• Parts of the machine may have toner on them. If the
defects occur on the back of the page, the problem will
likely correct itself after a few more pages.
• The fusing assembly may be damaged. Contact a service
representative.
Background scatter results from bits of toner randomly
distributed on the printed page.
• The paper may be too damp. Try printing with a different
batch of paper. Do not open packages of paper until
necessary so that the paper does not absorb too much
moisture.
• Check the paper type and quality (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
Vertical
repetitive
defects
Suggested Solutions
• If background scatter covers the entire surface area of a
printed page, adjust the print resolution through your
software application or in Printing Preferences (see
"Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
Toner particles
are around bold
characters or
pictures
The toner might not adhere properly to this type of paper.
• Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing
Preferences, click the Paper tab, and set the paper type to
Recycled (see "Opening printing preferences" on page
66).
• Ensure the correct paper type is selected. For example: If
Thicker Paper is selected, but Plain Paper actually used, an
overcharging can occur causing this copy quality problem.
9. Troubleshooting
220
Solving other problems
Condition
Misformed
characters
Suggested Solutions
• If characters are improperly formed and producing hollow
images, the paper stock may be too slick. Try different
paper (see "Print media specifications" on page 249).
Condition
Wrinkles or
creases
• If characters are improperly formed and producing a wavy
effect, the scanner unit may need service. Cleaning the
scan unit or contact a service representative.
Page skew
• Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.
• Check the paper type and quality (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
Suggested Solutions
• Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.
• Check the paper type and quality (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
• Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating
the paper 180° in the tray.
Back of
printouts are
dirty
Check for leaking toner. Clean the inside of the machine.
Cleaning the inside or contact a service representative.
Solid Color or
Black pages
• The imaging unit may not be installed properly. Remove
the imaging unit and reinsert it.
• Ensure that the paper or other material is loaded correctly
and the guides are not too tight or too loose against the
paper stack.
Curl or wave
• Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.
• Check the paper type and quality. Both high temperature
and humidity can cause paper curl (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
• Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating
the paper 180° in the tray.
• The imaging unit may be defective and need replacing.
Remove the imaging unit and install a new one. Contact a
service representative.
• The machine may require repair. Contact a service
representative.
9. Troubleshooting
221
Solving other problems
Condition
Loose toner
Suggested Solutions
• Clean the inside of the machine. Cleaning the inside or
contact a service representative.
If the printed paper is curled or paper does not feed into the
machine:
• Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also try rotating
the paper 180° in the tray.
• Remove the imaging unit and install a new one. Contact a
service representative.
• Change the printer option and try again. Go to Printing
Preferences, click Paper tab, and set type to thin paper
(see "Opening printing preferences" on page 66).
Character voids are white areas within parts of characters that
should be solid black:
• You may be printing on the wrong surface of the paper.
Remove the paper and turn it around.
• The paper may not meet paper specifications (see "Print
media specifications" on page 249).
Horizontal
stripes
Curl
Suggested Solutions
• Check the paper type and quality (see "Print media
specifications" on page 249).
• If the problem persists, the machine may require repair.
Contact a service representative.
Character Voids
Condition
An unknown
image
repetitively
appears on a
few sheets or
loose toner,
light print, or
contamination
occurs.
Your machine is probably being used at an altitude of 1,000 m
(3,281 ft) or above.The high altitude may affect the print
quality, such as loose toner or light imaging. Change the
correct altitude setting to your machine.
If horizontally aligned black streaks or smears appear:
• The imaging unit may be installed improperly. Remove the
imaging unit and reinsert it.
• The imaging unit may be defective. Remove the imaging
unit and install a new one. Contact a service
representative.
• If the problem persists, the machine may require repair.
Contact a service representative.
9. Troubleshooting
222
Solving other problems
14
Copying problems
Condition
Suggested solution
Copies are too light or too dark
Tap Copy from the home screen or Apps. You can adjust the darkness level of a copy if needed for easier reading if the original
contains faint markings or dark images (see "Changing Darkness" on page 95).
Smears, lines, marks, or spots
appear on copies.
• If the defects are on the original, tap Copy from the home screen or Apps (see "Changing Darkness" on page 95).
• If there are no defects on the original, clean the scan unit. Cleaning the scan unit or contact a service representative.
Copy image is skewed.
• Ensure that the original is face down on the scanner glass or face up in the DSDF.
• Check that the copy paper is loaded correctly.
• If the problem persists, the machine may require repair. Contact a service representative.
Blank copies print out.
Ensure that the original is face down on the scanner glass or face up in the DSDF.
Image rubs off the copy easily.
• Replace the paper in the tray with paper from a new package.
• In high humidity areas, do not leave paper in the machine for extended periods of time.
Frequent copy paper jams occur.
• Fan the stack of paper, then turn it over in the tray. Replace the paper in the tray with a fresh supply. Check/adjust the paper
guides, if necessary.
• Ensure that the paper is the proper paper weight.
• Check for copy paper or pieces of copy paper remaining in the machine after a paper jam has been cleared.
Toner cartridge produces fewer
copies than expected before
running out of toner.
• Your originals may contain pictures, solids, or heavy lines. For example, your originals may be forms, newsletters, books, or
other documents that use more toner.
• The DSDF may be left open while copies are being made.
• The machine may be turned on and off frequently.
9. Troubleshooting
223
Solving other problems
15
Scanning problems
Condition
The scanner does not work.
Suggested solutions
• Make sure that you place the original to be scanned face down on the scanner glass, or face up in the document feeder (see
"Loading originals" on page 45).
• There may not be enough available memory to hold the document you want to scan. Try the Prescan function to see if that works.
Try lowering the scan resolution rate.
• Check that the machine printer cable is connected properly.
• Make sure that the machine printer cable is not defective. Switch the printer cable with a known good cable. If necessary, replace
the printer cable.
• Check that the scanner is configured correctly. Check scan setting in the application you want to use to make certain that the
scanner job is being sent to the correct port (for example, USB001).
The unit scans very slowly.
• Check if the machine is printing received data. If so, scan the document after the received data has been printed.
• Graphics are scanned more slowly than text.
• Communication speed slows in scan mode because of the large amount of memory required to analyze and reproduce the scanned
image. Set your computer to the ECP printer mode through BIOS setting. It will help to increase the speed. For details about how
to set BIOS, refer to your computer user’s guide.
9. Troubleshooting
224
Solving other problems
Condition
Suggested solutions
Message appears on your
computer screen:
• There may be a copying or printing job in progress. Try your job again when that job is finished.
• Device can’t be set to the H/W
mode you want.
• The machine printer cable may be improperly connected or the power may be off.
• Port is being used by another
program.
• Ensure that the machine is properly connected and the power is on, then restart your computer.
• Port is disabled.
• The selected port is currently being used. Restart your computer and try again.
• The scanner driver is not installed or the operating environment is not set up properly.
• The USB cable may be improperly connected or the power may be off.
• Scanner is busy receiving or
printing data. When the
current job is completed, try
again.
• Invalid handle.
• Scanning has failed.
16
Faxing problems
Condition
The machine is not working,
there is no display, or the
buttons are not working.
Suggested solutions
• Unplug the power cord and plug it in again.
• Ensure that there is power being supplied to the electrical outlet.
• Ensure that the power is turned on.
9. Troubleshooting
225
Solving other problems
Condition
No dial tone.
Suggested solutions
• Check that the phone line is properly connected (see "Rear view" on page 22).
• Check that the phone socket on the wall is working by plugging in another phone.
• Find the optimal line for communication (see "General fax settings" on page 139).
The numbers stored in memory
do not dial correctly.
Make sure that the numbers are stored in memory correctly. To check that, print an address book list.
The original does not feed into
the machine.
• Make sure that the paper is not wrinkled and you are inserting it in correctly. Check that the original is the right size, not too thick
or thin.
• Make sure that the document feeder is firmly closed.
• The document feeder rubber pad may need to be replaced. Contact a service representative.
Faxes are not received
automatically.
• The receiving mode should be set to fax.
• Make sure that there is paper in the tray.
• Check to see if the display shows any error message. If it does, clear the problem.
• Find the optimal line for communication. To check that, see Smart Fax Diagnostics menu (see "General fax settings" on page 139).
The machine does not send.
• Make sure that the original is loaded in the document feeder or on the scanner glass.
• Check the fax machine you are sending to, to see if it can receive your fax.
• Find the optimal line for communication. To check that, see Smart Fax Diagnostics menu (see "General fax settings" on page 139).
The incoming fax has blank
spaces or is of poor-quality.
• The fax machine sending you the fax may be faulty.
• A noisy phone line can cause line errors.
• Check your machine by making a copy.
• A toner cartridge has almost reached its estimated cartridge life. Replace the toner cartridge (see "Replacing the toner cartridge"
on page 187).
• Find the optimal line for communication. To check that, see Smart Fax Diagnostics menu (see "General fax settings" on page 139).
9. Troubleshooting
226
Solving other problems
Condition
Suggested solutions
Some of the words on an
incoming fax are stretched.
The fax machine sending the fax had a temporary document jam.
There are lines on the originals
you sent.
Check your scan unit for marks and clean it (see "Cleaning the scan unit" on page 353).
The machine dials a number,
but the connection with the
other fax machine fails.
The other fax machine may be turned off, out of paper, or cannot answer incoming calls. Speak with the other machine operator and
ask them to solve the problem on their side.
Faxes do not store in memory.
There may not be enough memory space to store the fax. If the display indicating the memory status shows, delete any faxes you no
longer need from the memory, and then try to store the fax again. Call for service.
Blank areas appear at the
bottom of each page or on
other pages, with a small strip
of text at the top.
You may have chosen the wrong paper settings in the user option setting. Check the paper size and type again.
17
Operating system problems
Common Windows problems
Condition
“File in Use” message appears
during installation.
Suggested solutions
Exit all software applications. Remove all software from the startup group, then restart Windows. Reinstall the printer driver.
9. Troubleshooting
227
Solving other problems
Condition
Suggested solutions
“General Protection Fault”,
“Exception OE”, “Spool 32”, or
“Illegal Operation” messages
appear.
Close all other applications, reboot Windows and try printing again.
“Fail To Print”, “A printer
timeout error occurred”
message appear.
These messages may appear during printing. Just keep waiting until the machine finishes printing. If the message appears in
ready mode or after printing has completed, check the connection and/or whether an error has occurred.
Samsung Printer Experience is
not shown when you click more
settings.
Samsung Printer Experience is not installed. Download the app from the Windows Store and install it.
Machine information is not
displayed when you click the
device in the Devices and
Printers.
Check the Printer properties. Click the Ports tab.
(Control Panel > Devices and Printers > Right-click on your printer icon and select Printer properties)
If the port is set to File or LPT, uncheck them and select TCP/IP, USB, or WSD.
Refer to the Microsoft Windows User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Windows error messages.
9. Troubleshooting
228
Solving other problems
Common Mac problems
Condition
Suggested solutions
The machine does not print PDF
files correctly. Some parts of
graphics, text, or illustrations
are missing.
Printing the PDF file as an image may enable the file to print. Turn on Print As Image from the Acrobat printing options.
Some letters are not displayed
normally during cover page
printing.
Mac OS cannot create the font while printing the cover page. The English alphabet and numbers are displayed normally on
the cover page.
When printing a document in
Mac with Acrobat Reader 6.0 or
higher, colors print incorrectly.
Make sure that the resolution setting in your machine driver matches the one in Acrobat Reader.
It will take longer to print when you print a PDF file as an image.
Refer to the Mac User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Mac error messages.
9. Troubleshooting
229
Solving other problems
Common Linux problems
Condition
Suggested solutions
There is no xsane nor simplescan application on my Linux
machine.
For some Linux distributions, there might be no default scan application. To use scan features, install one of scan applications using
download center supplied by the OS(ex. Ubuntu Software Center for Ubuntu, Install/Remove Software for openSUSE, Software for
Fedora).
Scanner can not be found via
network.
For some Linux distributions, strong firewall is enabled and it may block our installer from opening the necessary port for searching
network devices. In such a case, open the snmp port - 22161 manually or disable the firewall temporarily while using the device.
When printing more than one
copy, the second copy does not
print.
The problem occurs on Ubuntu 12.04 due to the problem in standard CUPS filter 'pdftops'. Update 'cups-filters' package to version
1.0.18 to fix the problem ('pdftops' is a part of 'cups-filters' package).
Unchecking the collate option
in the Print Dialog does not
work.
For some distributions, GNOME Print Dialog has an issue handling the collate option. As workaround, set the default value of collate
option to False using the system's printing utility(execute "system-config-printer" in the Terminal program).
Printing always works with
duplex.
This duplex issue was in Ubuntu 9.10 CUPS package. Update CUPS version to 1.4.1-5ubuntu2.2.
Printer is not added through
system's printing utility.
The problem occurs on Debian 7 due to the defect in 'system-config-printer' package of the Debian 7 (http://bugs.debian.org/cgibin/bugreport.cgi?bug=662813 in Debian bug tracking system). Please use another way to add printer (CUPS WebUI for example)
Paper size and orientation are
disabled in the Print Dialog
when opening text files.
The problem occurs on Fedora 19 and it's related to 'leafpad' text editor on Fedora 19. Please use other text editors like 'gedit'.
Refer to the Linux User’s Guide that came with your computer for further information on Linux error messages.
9. Troubleshooting
230
Solving other problems
Common PostScript problems
The following situations are PS language specific and may occur when several printer languages are used.
Problem
The PostScript file cannot be
printed
Possible cause
The PostScript driver may not be installed
correctly.
Solution
• Install the PostScript driver.
• Print a configuration page and verify that the PS version is available for
printing.
• If the problem persists, contact a service representative.
Limit Check Error report prints
The print job was too complex.
You might need to reduce the complexity of the page or install more memory.
A PostScript error page prints
The print job may not be PostScript.
Make sure that the print job is a PostScript job. Check to see whether the software
application expected a setup or PostScript header file to be sent to the machine.
The optional tray is not
selected in the driver
The printer driver has not been configured to
recognize the optional tray.
Open the PostScript driver properties, select the Device Options tab, and set the
tray option.
When printing a document in
Mac with Acrobat Reader 6.0 or
higher, colors print incorrectly
The resolution setting in the printer driver may
not be matched with the one in Acrobat Reader.
Make sure that the resolution setting in your printer driver matches the one in
Acrobat Reader.
9. Troubleshooting
231
10.Supplies and Accessories
This guide provides information on purchasing Consumables, accessories and maintenance parts available for your
machine.
This chapter includes:
• Ordering supplies and accessories
233
• Available consumables
234
• Available accessories
235
• Installing accessories
237
• Available maintenance parts
236
• Checking replaceable’s lifespan
241
• Using a USB Drive device
242
Available accessories may differ from country to country. Contact your sales representatives to
obtain the list of available accessories.
Ordering supplies and accessories
Available accessories may differ from country to country. Contact your sales representatives to obtain the list of available supplies, and maintenance parts.
• See "Available consumables" on page 234.
• See "Available accessories" on page 235.
To order Samsung-authorized supplies, accessories, and maintenance parts, contact your local Samsung dealer or the retailer where you purchased your machine.
You can also visit www.samsung.com/supplies, and then select your country/region to obtain the contact information for service.
10. Supplies and Accessories
233
Available consumables
When supplies reach the end of their life spans, you can order the followings of supplies for your machine:
Type
Toner cartridgea
Average yield
Part name
Average continuous cartridge yield : Approx. 7,000 standard pages
• M4583 series: MLT-D304S
Average continuous cartridge yield : Approx. 20,000 standard pages
• M4583 series: MLT-D304L
Average continuous cartridge yield : Approx. 40,000 standard pages
• M4580 series: MLT-D303E
• M4583 series: MLT-D304E
Imaging unitb
Approx. 100,000 pages
• M4580 series: MLT-R303
• M4583 series: MLT-R304
a. Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/IEC 19752. The number of pages may be affected by operating environment, printing interval, graphics, media type and media size.
b. Based on simplex 3 average A4/Letter-size pages per job (and above mentioned coverage pattern). The number of pages may be affected by operating environment, printing interval, graphics,
media type and media size.
Depending on the options, percentage of image area and job mode used, the toner cartridge’s lifespan may differ.
When purchasing new toner cartridges or other supplies, these must be purchased in the same country as the machine you are using. Otherwise, new toner
cartridges or other supplies will be incompatible with your machine due to different configurations of toner cartridges and other supplies according to the specific
country conditions.
Samsung does not recommend using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridge such as refilled or remanufactured toner. Samsung cannot guarantee non-genuine
Samsung toner cartridge's quality. Service or repair required as a result of using non-genuine Samsung toner cartridges will not be covered under the machine’s
warranty.
10. Supplies and Accessories
234
Available accessories
You can purchase and install accessories to enhance your machine’s performance and capacity.
Some features and optional goods may not be available depending on model or country (see "Features by model" on page 8).
Accessory
Function
Part name
Memory module
Extends your machine’s memory capacity.
SL-MEM001: 2 GB
Optional tray
If you are experiencing frequent paper supply problems, you can attach an additional 550a
sheet tray.
SL-SCF4500
You can easily move the machine using the stand with its wheels.
SL-DSK001S
When using the optional Stand, you must
install the foot as shown in the Optional Stand
Install Guide provided with the optional
Stand. Otherwise, the machine could fall over
if on incline and cause bodily injury.
Stand
Wireless/NFC kit
This kit lets you use your machine as a Wireless and NFC machine.
SL-NWE001X
To purchase Wireless /NFC kit, contact the source where you bought the machine.
Installing Wireless /NFC kit can be performed only by an authorized service
provider, dealer, or the retailer where you bought the machine.
a. Plain paper 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond).
10. Supplies and Accessories
235
Available maintenance parts
You need to replace the maintenance parts at specific intervals to keep the machine in the best condition and avoid print quality and paper feeding problems
resulting from the worn-out parts. Maintenance parts are mostly rollers, belts and pads. However, the replacement period and parts may differ depending on the
model. Replacing maintenance parts can be performed only by an authorized service provider, dealer, or the retailer where you bought the machine. To purchase
maintenance parts, contact the retailer where you bought the machine. The replacement period for the maintenance parts is informed by the "Samsung Printer
Status" program. Or if your machine supports display screen, a message is displayed in the display screen. The replacement period varies based on the operating
system used, computing performance, application software, connecting method, paper type, paper size, and job complexity.
10. Supplies and Accessories
236
Installing accessories
1
2
Precautions
•
Disconnect the power cord
Never remove the control board cover while the power is turned on.
To avoid the possibility of an electrical shock, always disconnect the power
cord when installing or removing ANY internal or external accessories.
•
Discharge static electricity
The control board and internal accessories (network interface card or
memory module) are sensitive to static electricity. Before installing or
removing any internal accessories, discharge static electricity from your
body by touching something metal, such as the metal back plate on any
device plugged into a grounded power source. If you walk around before
finishing the installation, repeat this procedure to discharge any static
electricity again.
Setting Device Options
When you install the optional devices such as optional tray, memory, etc, this
machine automatically detects and sets the optional devices. If you cannot use
the optional devices you installed in this driver, you can set the optional devices
in Device Options.
1
Click the Windows Start menu.
•
2
When installing accessories, the battery inside the machine is a service
component. Do not change it by yourself. There is a risk of an explosion if
battery is replaced by an incorrect type. Dispose used batteries according to
the instructions.
3
4
For Windows 8, from the Charms, select Search > Settings.
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.
•
For Windows 2008/Vista, select Control Panel > Hardware and
Sound > Printers.
•
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >
Devices and Printers.
•
For Windows 8, search for Devices and Printers.
•
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >
Devices and Printers.
Right-click your machine.
For Windows XP/2003/2008/Vista, press Properties.
For Windows 7, Windows 8, and Windows Server 2008 R2, from context
menus, select the Printer properties.
10. Supplies and Accessories
237
Installing accessories
•
If Printer properties item has ▶ mark, you can select other printer drivers
connected with selected printer.
5
Select Device Options.
The Properties window may differ depending on the driver or operating
system you are using.
6
•
Tray Options: Select the optional tray you installed. You can select
the tray.
•
Storage Options: Select the optional memory you installed. If this
feature is checked, you can select the Print Mode.
•
Printer Configuration: Select the printer language for the print job.
•
Administrator Settings: You can select the Printer Status and EMF
Spooling.
-
User permission: If you check this option, only users with user
permission can start a print job.
-
Group permission: If you check this option, only groups with
group permission can start a print job.
If you want to encrypt job accounting password, check Job Accounting
Password Encryption.
Select the appropriate option.
Some menus may not appear in the display depending on options or
models. if so, it is not applicable to your machine.
Admin Job Accounting: Allows you to associate user and account
identification information with each document you print.
•
7
Custom Paper Size Settings: You can specify custom paper size.
Click OK until you exit the Properties or Printer properties window.
10. Supplies and Accessories
238
Installing accessories
3
Upgrading a memory module
Your machine has a dual in-line memory module (DIMM). Use this memory module slot to install additional memory. We recommend the use of only genuine
Samsung DIMM's. You may void your warranty if it is determined that your machine problem is being caused by third party DIMM's.
The order information is provided for optional accessories (see "Available accessories" on page 235).
10. Supplies and Accessories
239
Installing accessories
After installing the optional memory, you can use the advanced printing features, such as proofing a job and specifying of printing a secure print job in the printer
properties window. You can control the active job queue and file policy (see "Using Box" on page 181).
10. Supplies and Accessories
240
Checking replaceable’s lifespan
If you experience frequent paper jams or printing problems, check the
remaining lifespan of Consumables. Replace the corresponding parts, if
necessary.
1
2
Tap Settings > Management > Supplies Life from the main screen.
Check the consumables life.
10. Supplies and Accessories
241
Using a USB Drive device
This chapter explains how to use a USB Drive device with your machine.
You must use only an authorized USB Drive device with an A plug type
connector.
4
Understanding the USB screen
To use the USB feature, tap Box > USB from the home screen or Apps.
Documents and images printed and sent from USB can be stored in the Box (see
"Using Box" on page 181).
Use only a USB Drive device with metal-shielded connector.
5
About USB Drive device
USB Drive devices are available with a variety of memory capacities to give you
more room for storing documents, presentations, music and videos, high
resolution photographs, or whatever other files you want to store or move.
Only use a USB Drive device that has obtained compatibility certification;
otherwise, the machine might not recognize it.
Insert a USB Drive device into the USB port on your machine.
You can do the following on your machine using a USB Drive device:
•
Scan documents and save them on a USB Drive device.
•
Print data stored on a USB Drive device.
•
Format the USB Drive device.
Your machine supports USB Drive devices with FAT16/FAT32 and sector size of
512 bytes.
Check your USB Drive device’s file system from your dealer.
10. Supplies and Accessories
242
Using a USB Drive device
6
Do not insert the USB Drive device to other ports except the ports which is
as shown below the image. If you insert the USB Drive device to other ports,
the machine shows warning message on the display screen.
Printing from a USB Drive device
You can directly print files stored on a USB Drive device. You can print TIFF, JPEG
and PRN files.
USB print option supported file types:
• Do not remove the USB Drive device while it is in use. The machine
warranty does not cover damage caused by a user’s misuse.
•
PRN: Only files created by provided driver with your machine are
compatible. PRN files can be created by selecting the Print to file check box
when you print a document. The document will be saved as a PRN file, rather
than printed on paper. Only PRN files created in this fashion can be printed
directly from USB Drive device (see "Printing to a file (PRN)" on page 86).
•
TIFF: TIFF 6.0 Baseline
•
JPEG: JPEG Baseline
•
PDF: PDF 1.7 and below
In case of 8bit CMYK JPEG files, Job could be cancelled.
• If your USB Drive device has certain features, such as security settings and
password settings, your machine may not automatically detect it. For
details about these features, see USB Drive device’s User’s Guide.
To print a document from a USB Drive device:
10. Supplies and Accessories
243
Using a USB Drive device
1
Insert a USB Drive device into the USB port on your machine.
5
Your machine automatically detects the device and reads data stored on
it (see "About USB Drive device" on page 242).
• The machine cannot detect the unformatted USB Drive device. Format,
and then reinsert the USB Drive device into the USB port on your
machine.
• If the machine did not detect your USB Drive when themachine is in
power save mode. Wake up the device and wait until the machine
returns to ready state. Then reinsert the USB Drive back into the USB port
on the front of your device.
2
3
Tap Box > USB from the home screen or Apps.
The machine shows all files in the USB Drive device.
Touch and hold folder or document you want to print from the list.
If the PDF file you selected is secured with a password, you have to know the
password for printing. Enter the password when the machine requires the
secure password. If you do not know the password, the print job will be
cancelled.
4
Tap
6
7
Select the appropriate option.
•
Copies: Selects the number of copies.
•
Paper Source: Select from which tray the paper is used.
•
Auto fit: Allows you to scale your print job to the selected paper size
in the tray regardless of the document size. Select a tray, and press
On.
Tap
icon to begin printing.
After printing is completed, you can remove the USB Drive device from
the machine.
7
Managing USB Drive device
You can delete image files stored on a USB Drive one-by-one or all at once by
reformatting the device.
After deleting files or reformatting a USB Drive device, files cannot be
restored. Confirm that you no longer need the data before deleting it.
> Print Options.
10. Supplies and Accessories
244
Using a USB Drive device
Deleting an image file
If the file is in a folder, press the folder name.
1
2
3
Insert a USB Drive device into the USB port on your machine.
Tap Box > USB from the home screen or Apps.
The machine shows all files in the USB Drive device.
4
5
Tap
> Format.
Tap Format when the confirmation window appears.
Touch and hold folder or document you want to delete from the list.
If the file is in a folder, press the folder name.
4
5
Tap
> Delete.
Tap Delete when the confirmation window appears.
Formatting a USB Drive device
1
2
3
Insert a USB Drive device into the USB port on your machine.
Tap Box > USB from the home screen or Apps.
The machine shows all files in the USB Drive device.
Touch and hold folder or document you want to delete from the list.
10. Supplies and Accessories
245
11.Appendix
This chapter provides product specifications and information concerning applicable regulations.
• Specifications
247
• Regulatory information
257
• Copyright
269
Specifications
1
General specifications
The specification values listed below are subject to change without notice. See www.samsung.com for possible changes in information.
Items
Description
Dimensiona
Width x Length x Height
530 x 459.5 x 649 mm (20.87 x 18.09 x 25.55 inches)
Weighta
Machine with consumables
32.04 kg (70.64 lbs)
Noise Levelb c
Ready mode
Less than 30 dB (A)
Print mode
Less than 54 dB (A)
Copy/ Scan
mode
Temperature
Humidity
Power ratingd
Scanner glass
Less than 56 dB (A)
Document feeder
Less than 56 dB (A)
Operation
10 to 30°C (50 to 86 °F)
Storage (packed)
-20 to 40°C (-4 to 104 °F)
Operation
20 to 80% RH
Storage (packed)
10 to 90% RH
110 volt models
AC 110 - 127 V
220 volt models
AC 220 - 240 V
11. Appendix
247
Specifications
Items
Power consumptione
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
Description
Average operating mode
Less than 900 W
Ready mode
Less than 30 W
Power save mode
Less than 1.8 W
Power off modef
Less than 0.45 W
Dimensions and weight are measured without a handset and other accessories.
Sound Pressure Level, ISO 7779. Configuration tested: basic machine installation, A4 paper, simplex printing.
China only: If the equipment's noise is louder than 63 db (A), the equipment should be placed in region of relatively independent advice.
See the rating label on the machine for the correct voltage (V), frequency (hertz) and of current (A) for your machine.
The power consumption may be affected by the machine’s status, setting conditions, operating environment, and measuring equipment and method the country uses.
Power consumption can be completely avoided only when the power cable is not connected.
11. Appendix
248
Specifications
2
Print media specifications
Type
Size
print media weighta/Capacityb
Dimensions
Tray1 / Optional tray
Multi-purpose tray
Letter
216 x 279 mm (8.5 x 11 inches)
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb bond)
70 to 90 g/m2 (19 to 24 lb bond)
Legal
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)
• 550 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)
• 100 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)
US Folio
216 x 330 mm (8.5 x 13 inches)
A4
210 x 297 mm (8.26 x 11.69 inches)
Oficio
216 x 343 mm (8.5 x 13.5 inches)
JIS B5
182 x 257 mm (7.16 x 10.11 inches)
ISO B5
176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 inches)
Executive
184 x 267 mm (7.25 x 10.5 inches)
A5
148 x 210 mm (5.82 x 8.26 inches)
Statement
140 x 216 mm (5.5 x 8.5 inches)
A6
105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.82 inches)
Not available in optional tray.
Index Card
76 x 127 mm (3.00 x 5.00 inches)
Not available in tray1/optional tray.
Postcard 4 x 6
102 x 152 mm (4.00 x 6.00 inches)
Not available in optional tray.
Postcard 100 x 148
100 x 148 mm (3.94 x 5.83 inches)
Not available in optional tray.
Plain paper
11. Appendix
249
Specifications
Type
Size
print media weighta/Capacityb
Dimensions
Tray1 / Optional tray
Multi-purpose tray
Envelope Monarch
98 x 191 mm (3.87 x 7.5 inches)
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
Envelope No. 9
98 x 225 mm (3.87 x 8.87 inches)
• 50 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)
• 10 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)
Envelope No. 10
105 x 241 mm (4.12 x 9.5 inches)
Envelope DL
110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 inches)
Envelope C5
162 x 229 mm (6.37 x 9.01 inches)
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
Envelope C6
114 x 162 mm (4.48 x 6.38 inches)
• 50 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)
Thick paperd e
Refer to the Plain paper
section
Refer to the Plain paper section
91 to 120 g/m2 (24 to 32 lb bond)
90 to 120 g/m2 (24 to 32 lb bond)
Thicker paper
Refer to the Plain paper
section
Refer to the Plain paper section
Not available in tray1/optional tray.
164 to 220 g/m2 (44 to 59 lb bond)
Thin paper
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
60 to 69 g/m2 (16 to 19 lb bond)
60 to 69 g/m2 (16 to 19 lb bond)
• 550 sheets
• 100 sheets
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5, A6,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lb bond)
120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lb bond)
• 50 sheets
• 10 sheets
Refer to the Plain paper
section
Refer to the Plain paper section
121 to 163 g/m2 ( 32 to 43lb bond)
121 to 163 g/m2 ( 32 to 43lb bond)
• 50 sheets
• 10 sheets
Envelopec
Labelsf g
Card stockd
11. Appendix
250
Specifications
Type
Size
print media weighta/Capacityb
Dimensions
Tray1 / Optional tray
Multi-purpose tray
Recycled
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
60 to 90 g/m2 ( 16 to 24 lb bond)
60 to 90 g/m2 ( 16 to 24 lb bond)
Preprinted
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
75 to 90 g/m2 ( 20 to 24 lb bond)
75 to 90 g/m2 ( 20 to 24 lb bond)
Bond
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
105 to 120 g/m2 ( 28 to 32 lb bond)
105 to 120 g/m2 ( 28 to 32 lb bond)
Colored,
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Cotton,
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Punched Paper Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
Letter, Legal, Oficio, US
Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement
Refer to the Plain paper section
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb bond)
Letterheadg
11. Appendix
251
Specifications
Type
Size
print media weighta/Capacityb
Dimensions
Tray1 / Optional tray
Letter, Legal, US Folio,
A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,
Executive, A5,
Statement, PostCard 4
x 6, PostCard 100 x 148
Refer to the Plain paper section
75 to 90 g/m2 ( 20 to 24 lb bond)
Minimum size (custom)
76.2 x 127 mm (3 x 5 inches)
60 to 163 g/m2 (16 to 43 lb bond)
Maximum size (custom)
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)
Archivee
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
f.
g.
Multi-purpose tray
75 to 90 g/m2 ( 20 to 24 lb bond)
If media weight is over 105 g/m2 (28 lb bond), load a paper into the tray one by one.
Maximum capacity may differ depending on media weight, thickness, and environmental conditions.
Envelope Monarch and Envelope C6 are not supported for optional tray.
Index Card is supported only multi-purpose tray.
A6, PostCard 4 x 6, and PostCard 100 x 148 are not supported for optional tray.
Smoothness: 100 to 250 (sheffield)
A6 is supported only multi-purpose tray/tray1.
11. Appendix
252
Specifications
3
System requirements
Microsoft® Windows®
Requirement (recommended)
Operating system
CPU
RAM
free HDD space
Windows® XP
Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)
128 MB (256 MB)
1.5 GB
Windows Server® 2003
Intel® Pentium® III 933 MHz (Pentium IV 1 GHz)
128 MB (512 MB)
1.25 GB to 2 GB
Windows Server® 2008
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz (Pentium IV 2 GHz)
512 MB (2 GB)
10 GB
Windows Vista®
Intel® Pentium® IV 3 GHz
512 MB (1 GB)
15 GB
Windows® 7
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32-bit or 64-bit processor or higher
1 GB (2 GB)
16 GB
• Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory (to enable the Aero theme).
• DVD-R/W Drive
Windows Server® 2008 R2
Intel® Pentium® IV 1.4 GHz (x64) processors (2 GHz or faster)
512 MB (2 GB)
10 GB
Windows® 8
Intel® Pentium® IV 1 GHz 32-bit or 64-bit processor or higher
2 GB
20 GB
Windows® 8.1
• Support for DirectX® 9 graphics with 128 MB memory (to enable the Aero theme).
512 MB (2 GB)
32 GB
• DVD-R/W Drive
Windows Server® 2012
Intel® Pentium® IV 1.4 GHz (x64) processors (2 GHz or faster)
Windows Server® 2012 R2
11. Appendix
253
Specifications
• Internet Explorer 6.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all Windows operating systems.
• Users who have administrator rights can install the software.
• Windows Terminal Services is compatible with your machine.
Mac
Requirements (Recommended)
Operating system
CPU
Mac OS X 10.5
• Intel® processors
RAM
Free HDD space
512 MB (1 GB)
1 GB
• 867 MHz or faster Power PC G4/G5
Mac OS X 10.6
• Intel® processors
1 GB (2 GB)
1 GB
Mac OS X 10.7 - 10.9
• Intel® processors
2 GB
4 GB
11. Appendix
254
Specifications
Linux
Items
Requirements
Operating system
RedHat® Enterprise Linux WS 5, 6
Fedora 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19
OpenSuSE® 11.0, 11.1, 11.2, 11.3, 11.4, 12.1, 12.2, 12.3
Ubuntu 10.04, 10.10, 11.04 , 11.10, 12.04, 12.10, 13.04
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11
Debian 5.0, 6.0, 7.0, 7.1
Mint 13, 14, 15
CPU
Pentium IV 2.4GHz (Intel Core™2)
RAM
512 MB (1 GB)
Free HDD space
1 GB (2 GB)
Unix
Items
Requirements
Sun Solaris 9, 10, 11 (x86, SPARC)
Operating system
HP-UX 11.0, 11i v1, 11i v2, 11i v3 (PA-RISC, Itanium)
IBM AIX 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 6.1 7.1 (PowerPC)
11. Appendix
255
Specifications
Items
Free HDD space
Requirements
Up to 100 MB
4
Network environment
You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your network machine. The following table shows the network environments supported by the
machine.
Items
Network interface
Specifications
• Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base-TX Wired Lan
• Network Interface 802.11b/g/n wireless LAN & Near Field Communication(NFC)a
Network operating system
• Windows® XP, Windows Server® 2003, Windows Vista®, Windows® 7, Windows® 8, Windows Server® 2008 R2
• Various Linux OS
• Mac OS X 10.5 - 10.9
• UNIX OS
Network protocols
• TCP/IPv4
• DHCP, BOOTP
• DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP
• Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR, IPP, WSD, AirPrint, Google Cloud Print
• SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP, IPSec
• TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR, SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP, IPSec)
a. Optional device
11. Appendix
256
Regulatory information
This machine is designed for a normal work environment and certified with
several regulatory statements.
When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be
followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons:
5
Laser safety statement
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21
CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is
certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 608251 : 2007.
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and
printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above
a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance or prescribed service
condition.
Warning
Never operate or service the printer with the protective cover removed from
laser/scanner assembly. The reflected beam, although invisible, can damage
your eyes.
6
Taiwan only
11. Appendix
257
Regulatory information
7
10
Ozone safety
Power saver
This product’s ozone emission rate is under 0.1 ppm. Because
ozone is heavier than air, keep the product in a place with good
ventilation.
This printer contains advanced energy conservation technology that
reduces power consumption when it is not in active use.
When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of
time, power consumption is automatically lowered.
8
ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are registered U.S. marks.
Mercury Safety
For more information on the ENERGY STAR program see http://
www.energystar.gov
For ENERGY STAR certified models, the ENRGY STAR label will be on
your machine. Check if your machine is ENERGY STAR certified.
Contains Mercury, Dispose According to Local, State or Federal
Laws.(U.S.A. only)
11
Recycling
9
Perchlorate warning
This Perchlorate warning applies only to primary CR (Manganese Dioxide)
Lithium coin cells in the product sold or distributed ONLY in California USA.
Recycle or dispose of the packaging material for this product in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Perchlorate Material - special handling may apply.
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate. (U.S.A. only)
11. Appendix
258
Regulatory information
12
13
China only
Correct disposal of this product (Waste electrical &
electronic equipment)
(Applicable in countries with separate collection
systems)
Website: http://www.samsung.com/cn/support/location/
supportServiceLocation.do?page=SERVICE.LOCATION
This marking on the product, accessories or literature indicates that the
product and its electronic accessories (e.g. charger, headset, USB cable)
should not be disposed of with other household waste at the end of
their working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or
human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate these
items from other s of waste and recycle them responsibly to promote the
sustainable reuse of material resources.
Household users should contact either the retailer where they
purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of
where and how they can take these items for environmentally safe
recycling.
Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and
conditions of the purchase contract. This product and its electronic
accessories should not be mixed with other commercial wastes for
disposal.
11. Appendix
259
Regulatory information
(The United States of America only)
16
Radio frequency emissions
Dispose unwanted electronics through an approved recycler. To find the nearest
recycling location, go to our website: www.samsung.com/recyclingdirect Or
call, (877) 278 - 0799
14
State of California Proposition 65 Warning (USA
Only)
15
Taiwan only
FCC information to the user
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions:
•
This device may not cause harmful interference, and
•
This device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class
A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed
to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential
installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency
energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may
cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this
equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception,
which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is
encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following
measures:
•
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
•
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
•
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to
which the receiver is connected.
11. Appendix
260
Regulatory information
•
Consult the dealer or experienced radio TV technician for help.
18
Taiwan only
Change or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer
responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the
equipment.
Canadian radio interference regulations
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits for radio noise
emissions from digital apparatus as set out in the interference-causing
equipment standard entitled “Digital Apparatus”, ICES-003 of the Industry and
Science Canada.
19
Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques
applicables aux appareils numériques de Class A prescrites dans la norme sur le
matériel brouilleur: “Appareils Numériques”, ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et
Sciences Canada.
Russia/Kazakhstan/Belaru only
17
RFID (Radio Frequency Interface Device)
RFID operation is subject to the following two conditions:(1) this device may not
cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including
interference that may cause undesired operation of the device. (U.S.A., France,
Taiwan only)
11. Appendix
261
Regulatory information
20
Germany only
21
Turkey only
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is an indication of the maximum number
of devices allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The termination of
an interface may consist of any combination of devices subject only to the
requirement that the sum of the RENs of all the devices not exceed five. / L’indice
d’equivalence de la sonnerie (IES) sert a indiquer le nombre maximal de
terminaux qui peuvent etre raccordes a une interface telephonique. La
terminaison d’une interface peut consister en une combinaison quelconque de
dispositifs, a la seule condition que la somme d’indices d’equivalence de la
sonnerie de tous les dispositifs n’excede pas cinq.
24
Fax Branding
22
Thailand only
This telecommunication equipment conforms to NTC technical requirement.
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any
person to use a computer or other electronic device to send any message via a
telephone facsimile machine unless such message clearly contains in a margin
at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the
transmission the following information:
1 the date and time of transmission
23
Canada only
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications. / Le
present materiel est conforme aux specifications techniques applicables
d’Industrie Canada.
2 identification of either business, business entity or individual sending the
message; and
3 telephone number of either the sending machine, business, business entity
or individual.
11. Appendix
262
Regulatory information
The Telephone Company may make changes in its communications facilities,
equipment operations or procedures where such action is reasonably required
in the operation of its business and is not inconsistent with the rules and
regulations in FCC Part 68. If such changes can be reasonably expected to render
any customer terminal equipment incompatible with telephone company
communications facilities, or require modification or alteration of such terminal
equipment, or otherwise materially affect its use or performance, the customer
shall be given adequate notice in writing, to allow the customer an opportunity
to maintain uninterrupted service
The equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements
adopted by the ACTA. On the rear of this equipment is a label that contains,
among other information, a product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX.
If requested, this number must be provided to the telephone company.
FCC Regulations state that changes or modifications to this equipment not
expressly approved by the manufacturer could void the user’s authority to
operate this equipment. In the event that terminal equipment causes harm
to the telephone network, the telephone company should notify the
customer that service may be stopped. However, where prior notice is
impractical, the company may temporarily cease service, providing that
they:
25
Ringer Equivalence Number
a promptly notify the customer.
b give the customer an opportunity to correct the equipment problem.
c inform the customer of the right to bring a complaint to the Federal
Communication Commission pursuant to procedures set out in FCC
Rules and Regulations Subpart E of Part 68.
The Ringer Equivalence Number and FCC Registration Number for this machine
may be found on the label located on the bottom or rear of the machine. In some
instances you may need to provide these numbers to the telephone company.
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is a measure of the electrical load placed
on the telephone line, and is useful for determining whether you have
“overloaded” the line. Installing several s of equipment on the same telephone
line may result in problems making and receiving telephone calls, especially
ringing when your line is called. The sum of all Ringer Equivalence Numbers of
the equipment on your telephone line should be less than five in order to assure
proper service from the telephone company. In some cases, a sum of five may
not be usable on your line. If any of your telephone equipment is not operating
properly, you should immediately remove it from your telephone line, as it may
cause harm to the telephone network.
You should also know that:
•
Your machine is not designed to be connected to a digital PBX system.
•
If you intend to use a computer modem or fax modem on the same phone
line as your machine, you may experience transmission and reception
problems with all the equipment. It is recommended that no other
equipment, except for a regular telephone, share the line with your
machine.
11. Appendix
263
Regulatory information
•
If your area experiences a high incidence of lightning or power surges, we
recommend that you install surge protectors for both the power and the
telephone lines. Surge protectors can be purchased from your dealer or
telephone and electronic specialty stores.
•
When programming emergency numbers and/or making test calls to
emergency numbers, use a non-emergency number to advise the
emergency service dispatcher of your intentions. The dispatcher will give
you further instructions on how to actually test the emergency number.
•
This machine may not be used on coin service or party lines.
•
This machine provides magnetic coupling to hearing aids.
The 13 amp plug is the most widely used in the UK and should be suitable.
However, some buildings (mainly old ones) do not have normal 13 amp plug
sockets. You need to buy a suitable plug adaptor. Do not remove the moulded
plug.
If you cut off the moulded plug, get rid of it straight away.You cannot rewire
the plug and you may receive an electric shock if you plug it into a socket.
Important warning:
You may safely connect this equipment to the telephone network by means of
a standard modular jack, USOC RJ-11C.
You must earth this machine.
The wires in the mains lead have the following color code:
26
Replacing the Fitted Plug (for UK Only)
• Green and Yellow: Earth
• Blue: Neutral
• Brown: Live
Important
The mains lead for this machine is fitted with a standard (BS 1363) 13 amp plug
and has a 13 amp fuse. When you change or examine the fuse, you must re-fit
the correct 13 amp fuse. You then need to replace the fuse cover. If you have lost
the fuse cover, do not use the plug until you have another fuse cover.
Contact the people from you purchased the machine.
If the wires in the mains lead do not match the colors marked in your plug, do
the following:
You must connect the green and yellow wire to the pin marked by the letter “E”
or by the safety ‘Earth symbol’ or colored green and yellow or green.
You must connect the blue wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “N” or
colored black.
You must connect the brown wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “L”
or colored red.
11. Appendix
264
Regulatory information
You must have a 13 amp fuse in the plug, adaptor, or at the distribution board.
27
Declaration of conformity (European countries)
Approvals and Certifications
Hereby, Samsung Electronics, declares that this [M458x series] is in
compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant
provisions of R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC.
The declaration of conformity may be consulted at
www.samsung.com, go to Support > Download center and enter
your printer (MFP) name to browse the EuDoC.
January 1, 1995: Council Directive 2006/95/EC Approximation of the laws of
the member states related to low voltage equipment.
January 1, 1996: Council Directive 2004/108/EC, approximation of the laws of
the Member States related to electromagnetic compatibility.
EC Certification
Certification to 1999/5/EC Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal
Equipment Directive (FAX)
This Samsung product has been self-certified by Samsung for pan-European
single terminal connection to the analogue public switched telephone network
(PSTN) in accordance with Directive 1999/5/EC. The product has been designed
to work with the national PSTNs and compatible PBXs of the European
countries:
In the event of problems, you should contact the Euro QA Lab of Samsung
Electronics Co., Ltd. in the first instance.
The product has been tested against TBR21. To assist in the use and application
of terminal equipment which complies with this standard, the European
Telecommunication Standards Institute (ETSI) has issued an advisory document
(EG 201 121) which contains notes and additional requirements to ensure
network compatibility of TBR21 terminals. The product has been designed
against, and is fully compliant with, all of the relevant advisory notes contained
in this document.
March 9, 1999: Council Directive 1999/5/EC on radio equipment and
telecommunications terminal equipment and the mutual recognition of their
conformity. A full declaration, defining the relevant Directives and referenced
standards can be obtained from your Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
representative.
11. Appendix
265
Regulatory information
European radio approval information (for products
fitted with EU-approved radio devices)
Low power, Radio LAN type devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless
communication devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz band, may be present
(embedded) in your printer system which is intended for home or office use. This
section is only applicable if these devices are present. Refer to the system label
to verify the presence of wireless devices.
Wireless devices that may be in your system are only qualified for
use in the European Union or associated areas if a CE mark is on the
system label.
The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in
your printer is well below the RF exposure limits as set by the European
Commission through the R&TTE directive.
European states qualified under wireless approvals:
EU countries
European states with restrictions on use:
EU
EEA/EFTA countries
28
Regulatory compliance statements
Wireless guidance
Low power, Radio LAN devices (radio frequency (RF) wireless communication
devices), operating in the 2.4 GHz/5 GHz Band, may be present (embedded) in
your printer system. The following section is a general overview of
considerations while operating a wireless device.
Additional limitations, cautions, and concerns for specific countries are listed in
the specific country sections (or country group sections). The wireless devices in
your system are only qualified for use in the countries identified by the Radio
Approval Marks on the system rating label. If the country you will be using the
wireless device in, is not listed, contact your local Radio Approval agency for
requirements. Wireless devices are closely regulated and use may not be
allowed.
The power output of the wireless device or devices that may be embedded in
your printer is well below the RF exposure limits as known at this time. Because
the wireless devices (which may be embedded into your printer) emit less
energy than is allowed in radio frequency safety standards and
recommendations, manufacturer believes these devices are safe for use.
Regardless of the power levels, care should be taken to minimize human contact
during normal operation.
No limitations at this time
11. Appendix
266
Regulatory information
As a general guideline, a separation of 20 cm (8 inches) between the wireless
device and the body, for use of a wireless device near the body (this does not
include extremities) is typical. This device should be used more than 20 cm (8
inches) from the body when wireless devices are on and transmitting.
This transmitter must not be collocated or operation in conjunction with any
other antenna or transmitter.
Some circumstances require restrictions on wireless devices. Examples of
common restrictions are listed below:
Radio frequency wireless communication can interfere with
equipment on commercial aircraft. Current aviation regulations
require wireless devices to be turned off while traveling in an airplane.
IEEE 802.11 (also known as wireless Ethernet) and Bluetooth
communication devices are examples of devices that provide wireless
communication.
Every country has different restrictions on the use of wireless devices.
Since your system is equipped with a wireless device, when traveling
between countries with your system, check with the local Radio
Approval authorities prior to any move or trip for any restrictions on
the use of a wireless device in the destination country.
If your system came equipped with an internal embedded wireless
device, do not operate the wireless device unless all covers and shields
are in place and the system is fully assembled.
Wireless devices are not user serviceable. Do not modify them in any
way. Modification to a wireless device will void the authorization to
use it. Contact manufacturer for service.
Only use drivers approved for the country in which the device will be
used. See the manufacturer System Restoration Kit, or contact
manufacturer Technical Support for additional information.
In environments where the risk of interference to other devices or
services is harmful or perceived as harmful, the option to use a wireless
device may be restricted or eliminated. Airports, Hospitals, and
Oxygen or flammable gas laden atmospheres are limited examples
where use of wireless devices may be restricted or eliminated. When in
environments where you are uncertain of the sanction to use wireless
devices, ask the applicable authority for authorization prior to use or
turning on the wireless device.
11. Appendix
267
Regulatory information
29
China only
11. Appendix
268
Copyright
© 2014 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.
This user’s guide is provided for information purposes only. All information included herein is subject to change without notice.
Samsung Electronics is not responsible for any direct or indirect damages, arising from or related to use of this user’s guide.
•
Samsung and the Samsung logo are trademarks of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.
•
Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7/8, and Windows Server 2008 R2 are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
•
Microsoft, Internet Explorer, Excel, Word, PowerPoint, and Outlook are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and
other countries.
•
Google, Picasa, Google Cloud Print, Google Docs, Android and Gmail are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Google Inc.
•
iPad, iPhone, iPod touch, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S and other countries.
•
AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple Inc.
•
All other brand or product names are trademarks of their respective companies or organizations.
The software included in this product contains open source software. You may obtain the complete
corresponding source code for a period of three years after the last shipment of this product by sending an email
to mailto:oss.request@samsung.com. It is also possible to obtain the complete corresponding source code in a
physical medium such as a CD-ROM; a minimal charge will be required.
The following URL http://opensource.samsung.com/opensource/Samsung_M458x_Series/seq/28 leads
to the download page of the source code made available and open source license information as related
to this product. This offer is valid to anyone in receipt of this information.
QR code
REV.4.00
11. Appendix
269
User’s Guide
ADVANCED(ADMINISTRATOR’S
GUIDE)
This administrator’s guide provides advanced information for administrator’s to use and
manage the machine.
Some features may not be available depending on model or country.
BASIC
This guide provides information concerning installation, basic operation and troubleshooting on
Windows.
ADVANCED(ADMINISTRATOR’S GUIDE)
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
Convention
274
Intended audience
275
Security policies for administrators
276
Terminology used in this guide
277
2. Advanced Features for Settings
Menu
Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)
306
Print settings (Ports to set for network printing)
309
Set protocols
310
Network filtering settings
311
Installing driver over the network
312
Wireless network setup (Optional)
320
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
328
Supported Mobile Apps
338
AirPrint
340
Google Cloud Print™
341
Log-in
280
Language and Input
281
Machine
282
Monitoring the supplies life
344
Admin Settings
287
Setting supplies reorder notification
345
Management
295
Replacing & redistributing supplies
346
Network Settings
297
Finding the serial number
347
System
301
Clearing memory
348
Cleaning the machine
349
Tips for storing machine, supplies, and paper
355
Tips for moving the machine
356
Printing a demo page
357
3. Network Setup
Network environment
304
Accessing network setup
305
4. Maintenance
271
1. About this
Administrator’s Guide
This administrator’s guide provides advanced information for administrator’s to use and manage the machine. Your
machine provides features that are available only for administrators, such as remotely installing the driver or creating
the installer package. You can also refer to this guide for maintenance information (eg., cleaning the
machine, replacing toner cartridges). This guide provides instructional screen images, easy-to-read tables of
features, and step-by-step instructions.
• Read the safety information before using the machine.
• If you have a problem using the machine, refer to the troubleshooting chapter in the user’s
guide on the User’s Guide CD (see "Troubleshooting" on page 184).
• Terms used in this administrator’s guide are explained in the glossary chapter (see "Glossary"
on page 366).
• The illustrations in this administrator’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its
options or models but the procedures are the same.
• The screenshots/ some menus in this administrator’s guide may differ from your machine
depending on the machine’s firmware/driver version.
• The procedures in this administrator’s guide are mainly based on Windows 7.
Convention
The following table offers the conventions of this guide:
Convention
Description
Bold
For texts on the display or button names on the machine.
Note
Provides additional information or detailed specification of the
machine function and feature.
Caution
Gives users information to protect the machine from possible
mechanical damage or malfunction.
Example
Start
The date format may differ from country to country.
Do not touch the surface of the drum located in the toner cartridge
or imaging unit.
Footnote
Provides additional information on certain words or a phrase.
a. pages per minute
(“Cross-reference”)
Guides users to a reference page for the additional detailed
information.
(See "Glossary" on page 366.)
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
274
Intended audience
The expected user for this guide is an administrator with an understanding of:
•
General knowledge of machine and other optional parts.
•
Basic technical knowledge.
•
The network printing environment.
•
Network protocols – subnets, security features, addresses.
•
Windows operating systems on server and client computers.
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
275
Security policies for administrators
Administrators need to adhere to the following policies in order to securely
manage the machine:
•
The administrator should place the machine in a secure place where the
machine can be protected by the physical contact or modulation,
•
The administrator should be fully aware of the security policies the
organization has and follow them to manage the machine.
•
The administrator should give the right to use the machine to users
according to the security policies and procedures.
•
The administrator should not use the authority one has over the machine
with ill intention.
•
The administrator should manage the machine in a trusted network
supported environment.
•
The administrator should guarantee that the certifying service via
certification server is through a safe channel and is safely managed.
•
The administrator should provide a Time Stamp feature to keep an accurate
system log history.
•
The administrator should provide a safe secure network channel with SSL.
•
The administrator should save the system log files exported by the
Exporting feature in a safe place and protected.
•
The administrator should protect the machine from any unauthorized
contact with external interfaces.
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
276
Terminology used in this guide
The following terms are used throughout this guide in examples, instructions,
and descriptions:
Acronyms
Meaning
EAP-MSCHAPv2
Extensible Authentication Protocol-Microsoft ChallengeHandshake Authentication Protocol version 2
IP
Internet Protocol
HTTP
Hypertext Transfer Protocol
HTTPS
Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure
1
Synonym
Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below:
Terms
Synonym
PEAPv0/EAP- Protected Extensible Authentication Protocol version 0/
MS-CHAPv2 Extensible Authentication Protocol-Microsoft ChallengeHandshake Authentication Protocol version 2
Document
original
SMTP
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol
Paper
media, print media
MFP
Multi-Functional Peripheral/Multi-Functional Printer
Machine
printer, MFP, device
S/N
Serial Number
User’s Guide
manual, guide
SNMP
Simple Network Management Protocol
SNTP
Simple Network Time Protocol
TLS
Transport Layer Security
UPnP
Universal Plug and Play
MDNS
Multicast Domain Name System
LDAP
Lightweight Directory Access Protocol
SLP
Service Location Protocol
SMB
Server Message Block
SWS
SyncThru™Web Service
WINS
Windows Internet Name Service
WSD
Web Service for Device
2
Acronyms
The following acronyms are used throughout this guide in examples,
instructions, and descriptions:
Acronyms
Meaning
DBMS
Data Base Management System
EAP-MD5
Extensible Authentication Protocol-Message Digest 5
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
277
Terminology used in this guide
3
Glossary
(See "Glossary" on page 366.)
1. About this Administrator’s Guide
278
2. Advanced Features for
Settings Menu
This chapter explains the Settings menu provided by your machine. The Settings menu provides various options for
administrators to set in order to use the machine to its full capabilities.
This cer includes:
•
Log-in
280
•
Language and Input
281
•
Machine
282
•
Admin Settings
287
•
Management
295
•
Network Settings
297
• System
301
• This administrator’s guide mainly describes features administrators would often use and
settings to set before using the machine.
• For some options, you need to contact your local service provider to set the settings.
• Some menus may not appear on the display screen depending on the settings or models. If
so, it is not applicable to your machine.
• Some options are only available to the administrator depending on the authentication
settings selected (see "Authentication" on page 289).
Log-in
Depending on the authentication settings you selected, you may need to log-in
as an administrator to access some options under Settings menu (see
"Authentication" on page 289). Contact your network service provider or
network administrator for more information.
1
2
Tap Settings from the home screen or Apps.
Select the option you want. If the option is available for only the
administrator, log-in screen appears.
Enter the ID, Password, and Domain using the pop-up keyboard which
appears when you tap each field.
• Enter the ID and password you first set when you turned on the machine
(see "Initial settings (administrator only)" on page 291).
• You can also use the ID
button to find the recently used ID and
domain button to find the domain from the list stored in the machine.
• When you log-in, you can see the ID of the logged in user on the display.
3
Tap Log in.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
280
Language and Input
This menu allows you to configure the language in which to display the menus.
You can also set onscreen keyboard options.
2
Input
Tap Settings > Language and Input from the home screen or Apps.
Feature
Description
Language
Allows you to select the language.
Keyboard & Input Methods
You can change the keyboard used by your
machine.
Speech
When there is no input for a certain period of time, the machine cancels the held
job or exits the current menu and goes in to the default settings. You can set the
amount of time the machine will wait before it cancels a held job or exits the
current menu.
3
Keyboards and Input Methods
Allows you to set the speech settings for
Voiceinput.
Allows you to specify the keyboard that the machine uses.
1
•
Default: Select the default input language and method.
Language
4
Allows you to select the language that appears on the display screen.
Tap Settings > Language from the home screen or Apps then select the
language what you want.
Speech
•
Text-to-speech output: Provides audible readout of text, for example, the
contents of email messages.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
281
Machine
Before using the machine, set up the general settings.
Feature
Power Saver
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
Timers
Allows you to set the time for machine to
return to the default setting or cancel the held
job if there is no input for an extended time
(see "Timers (administrator only)" on page
285).
Ecoa
Allows you to set the Eco mode as a default
and change settings for Eco mode. Using Eco
mode can save printing resources (see "Eco"
on page 286).
Tap Settings > Machine from the home screen or Apps.
Description
Tray Settings
Allows you to adjust the current tray settings,
such as the paper type and tray priorities (see
"Tray settings" on page 282).
Sound
Allows you to set the volume for button
sound, notice alarm, and sounds occurring
during fax job. You can test the volume right
after you set the level (see "Sound" on page
283).
Display
Allows you to set the wallpaper, brightness, ,
and quick launch.
Storage
Management all application’s storage.
Adjustment
Allows you to adjust altitude, huminity,
image, and macine test functions.
Allows you to reduce energy consumption. If
you set this option, the machine goes into
power saving mode when not in use.
There are two power saving modes (see
"Power Saver" on page 284).
then click on any option you want to know about.
Feature
Description
a. Available for the administrator depending on the authentication settings selected (see
"Authentication" on page 289).
5
Tray settings
This feature allows you to check the current tray settings and change the
settings if necessary. There are many options available for setting the tray and
paper. Make the best use of the options to fit your needs for trays and paper.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
282
Machine
•
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Settings tab >
Machine Settings > System >Input Trays.
Feedback
-Haptic Feedback : Vibrate when soft keys are press and on certain UI
interaction.
-Vibration Intensity : Set your touch feedback vibration intensity.
7
If some options are grayed out, it means that the grayed-out option is not
supported for your machine or optional parts needed to use the option are
not installed.
6
Display
you can change various settings for the display.
•
Brightness: Allows you to adjust the LCD brightness.
•
Quick Launch: You can select the register at Quick Launch (Screen
capture, Applications, Search)
Sound
8
You can set the volume for button sound, notice alarm, and the sounds
occurring during a fax job. Using the slide bar select the desired volume and
press the Test button to test the volume.
•
Key Sound: Allows you to adjust the sound volume for when pressing the
button
•
Alarm Sound: Allows you to adjust the sound volume for when notice
alarm.
•
Fax Sound: Allows you to adjust the sound volume occurring during a fax
job. This option has other sub-options.
Storage
You can management the all application storage and shows all storage
informations.
If the machine’s power is cut off, you need to reset the correct time and date
once the power has been restored.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
283
Machine
-Auto Tone Adjustment : Performs a normal or full tone adjustment
sequence immediately.
9
Adjustment
You can choose the altitude of the place where your machine is located. You can
also adjustment the image management and checking the machine test.
• Normal: Automatically adjusts the color tone. This process takes
moretime than Quick, but it produces better results.
•
• Full: Changes the color table entirely to adjust the color tone.
Altitude Adjustment : You can choose the altitude of the place where your
machine is located. The print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure,
which is determined by the height of the machine above sea level.
Therefore, it is important to set the right altitude.
•
Machine Test: Allows you to adjust the tone level.
-Print Adjustment : Allows you to adjust the print area. When images are
printed off the page or shifted, adjust the print area.
-Normal: 0-1,000 m(3,280 ft)
-High1: 1,000 m(3,280 ft)-2,000 m(6,561 ft)
10
-High2: 2,000 m(6,561 ft)-3,000m(9,842 ft)
-High3: 3,000 m(9,842 ft)-4,000 m(13,123 ft)
-High4: 4,000 m(13,123 ft)-5,000 m(16,404 ft)
•
Humidity : Optimizes print quality according to the humidity in the
environment.
•
Custom Color: Allows you to adjust the level of print density and copy
darkness.
•
Tone Adjustment: Allows you to automatically adjust the color tone to
produce the best possible print quality.
Power Saver
When you are not using the machine for a while, use this option to save power.
The Power Save option can be wake up by pressing the display screen.
-Auto Tone Adjustment Activation: Instructs the machine to automatically
calibrate the tone at certain intervals. Activate this option to perform a
normal or full tone adjustment after a certain number or pages are
printed or the machine is not used for a certain period.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
284
Machine
Performance Optimization
11
Timers (administrator only)
When this option is On, you can wake up the machine from the power saving
mode with the following actions:
•
Pressing
(Power / Wakeup) on the control panel.
•
Loading paper in a tray.
•
Opening or closing the cover.
•
Pulling a tray out or pushing a tray in.
•
Place the originals in the DSDF.
•
Plug in the USB Drive device.
Low Power Save
Low Power Save option allows your machine to save power. When you are not
using the machine for a while, some parts of the machine automatically enter
Low Power Save option. Low Power Save option conserves less power than
Power Save option.
When there is no input for a certain period of time, the machine cancels the held
job or exits the current menu and goes in to the default settings. You can set the
amount of time the machine will wait before it cancels a held job or exits the
current menu.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Settings >
Machine Settings > System > Setup.
•
System Timeout: The machine returns to the Copy menu if there is no input
for the given time.
•
Held Job Timeout: When an error occurs while printing and there is no
signal from the computer, the machine holds a job for a specific time period
before deleting it.
•
Job Timeout: When there is no input for a certain period of time, the
machine cancels the current job. You can set the amount of time the
machine will wait before canceling the job.
Power Save
When you are not using the machine for a while, use this option to save power.
The machine conserves more power in Power Save option than in Low Power
Save mode.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
285
Machine
12
Eco
Allows you to save print resources and enables ecofriendly printing.
•
Default Eco Mode: Select whether to turn the Eco mode on or off.
On-Forced: Sets the Eco mode on. If a user wants to turn the Eco mode off,
the user needs to enter the password.
•
Eco Features Configuration: Setting the ECO fratures.
-Default Settings: The machine is set to Default Eco mode.
-Custom Settings: Change any necessary values.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
286
Admin Settings
This option is only available to administrators.
Feature
Print Settings
You can set print related settings. When there
is no specific input for printing options, the
machine prints with the settings you set here.
Set the frequently used printing settings. This
feature can be useful if your company has a
specific printing form (see "Print Settings" on
page 292).
Box Settings
Allows you to check the current box settings
and change the settings if necessary (see "Box
Settings" on page 293)
Report Settings
The paper source setting specifies the default
paper tray that the machine uses to print
reports.
Application Management
You can install or uninstall applications
license. If you add an application, you need to
activate the license of the installed
application. Some applications may not have
a license (see "Application Management" on
page 293)
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
Tap Settings > Admin Settings from the home screen or Apps.
Feature
Description
Security
Allows you to set up the security related
settings (see "Security" on page 288).
General Settings
Allows you to set up the genaral settings
(Measurement, Supplies Management,
Contention Management, and other
settings) (see "General Settings" on page 290).
Initial Settings
Allows you to set the basic settings needed to
be set before using the machine (see "Initial
settings (administrator only)" on page 291).
Fax Settings
You can set the default fax options. Set the
most frequently used fax settings (see
"General fax settings" on page 139).
Description
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
287
Admin Settings
•
Scheduled Image Overwrite: you can set the schedule to manually
overwrite the image.
•
Allows you to set up the security related settings.
Overwrite Method: You can select the method for overwriting the secure
non-volatile memory(hard).
Image Overwrite
-German VSITR: Select to overwrite the memory 7 times. When overwriting
for the 6 times, alternate 0x00 and 0xff are used to overwrite the disk,
and, in the 7th time, the disk is written with 0xAA.
13
Security
You can set the machine to overwrite data stored in the memory. The machine
overwrites the data with different patterns eliminating the possibilities of
recovery.
This feature may not be available depending on models or option kits
installed.
•
•
Automatic Image Overwrite: When a job is completed, there are temporal
images left in the memory. For security reasons, you can set the machine to
automatically overwrite secure non-volatile memory. If you want to secure
memory space, you can set the machine to automatically overwrite secure
non-volatile memory.
Manual Image Overwrite: When printing, copying, scanning, and faxing,
the machine temporarily uses memory space. For security reasons, you can
set the machine to manually overwrite secure non-volatile memory. If you
want to secure memory space, you can manually overwrite secure nonvolatile memory. You can set the machine to repeat the manual image
overwrite after the system is rebooted.
-DoD5220.28-M: Select to overwrite the memory 3 times. When
overwriting three times, patterns 0x35, 0xCA, 0x97 are used to overwrite
the disk’s content. This method of overwriting the disk is specified by US
DoD.
-Australian ACSI 33: Select to overwrite the memory 5 times. When
overwriting 5 times, character “C” and its complement alternatively are
used to overwrite the disk. After the 2nd time, there is a mandatory
validation. For the 5th time, random data is used.
-DoD 5220.22M (ECE): Select to overwrite the memory 3 times. When
overwriting three times, patterns 0x35, 0xCA, 0x97 are used to overwrite
the disk’s content. This method of overwriting the disk is specified by US
DoD.
-Custom Overwrite: Select to determine the number of times the memory
will be overwritten. The hard disk will be overwritten as many times as
the number you select.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
288
Admin Settings
Authentication
This feature allows you to choose the authentication method for user
authentication.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click the Security tab
> User Access Control (see "Authentication" on page 289).
▪Auto Logout: You can use auto logout.
▪Login Restriction: You can set the Login Restriction time, attempts, or
lock-out time.
▪Logout Policy: You can set the logout policy.
-SMB and Local Authentication: Executes authentication process based on
the user information stored at SMB server.
▪LUI Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For-LUI , by default.
▪SWS Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For SWS, by default.
▪Auto Logout: You can use auto logout.
•
Mode: Select the authentication mode.
-Basic Authentication: Activate basic authentication. Users are asked to
login when they select options that are only available to administrators.
Those options are marked with “a” or “(administrator only)” in this guide.
-Device Authentication: Activate device authentication. Device
authentication requests a user to login before being able to use the
device. Users cannot use any application without logging in.
-Application Authentication: Activate application authentication. An
administrator can choose the application(s) to require user to login to
use. Users cannot use the selected application(s) without logging-in.
Press Application Mode to enable authentication.
•
Method
-Local Authentication: Executes authentication process based on the user
information stored at HDD in the device.
▪LUI Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For-LUI , by default.
-Kerberos and Local Authentication: Executes authentication process
based on the user information stored at kerberos server.
▪LUI Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For-LUI , by default.
▪SWS Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For SWS, by default.
▪Auto Logout: You can use auto logout.
-LDAP and Local Authentication: Executes authentication process based
on the user information stored at LDAPserver.
▪LUI Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For-LUI , by default.
▪SWS Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For SWS, by default.
▪Auto Logout: You can use auto logout.
-SyncThruAaProvider: Executes authentication process based on the user
information allocated from SWS.
▪LUI Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For-LUI , by default.
▪SWS Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For SWS, by default.
▪SWS Login Screen: Provides Pre-Installed-For SWS, by default.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
289
Admin Settings
▪Auto Logout: You can use auto logout.
-Standard Accounting Only: Allows users to login by entering ID and
password.
▪ID/PW Login: You can login from ID&Password.
14
General Settings
Allows you to set up the genaral settings.
▪ID Only Login: You can login from ID only.
•
Secure Print: You can login from secure print.
Measurement
You can choose the measuring unit and default paper size.
Accounting
You can set usage limits for each user to use each feature if Standard
accounting method is chosen (see "Authentication" on page 289).
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click the Security tab
> User Access Control > Accounting > Accounting Methods (see
"Security tab" on page 163).
Supplies Management
Allows you to set options for supplies reorder notification. If you set this option,
the machine will display a warning message when the supplies are running out.
Prepare the supplies in advance.
• Imaging Unit Reorder Notification: Issues a notification when the
imaging unit has the specified lifespan remaining.
•
No Accounting: Select not to use this feature.
• Toner Cartridge Reorder Notification: Issues a notification when a
toner cartridge has the specified lifespan remaining.
•
Standard Accounting: Select to use the installed job accounting method.
• Toner Save: The Toner Save setting allows the user to save printing
toner when printing a document.
•
SyncThruaA Provider: Select to use the job accounting method provided
by the SyncThru™Web Admin Service (For detailed information, refer to the
SyncThru™Web Admin Service guide).
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
290
Admin Settings
Contention Management
If you want to stop adjusting the initial settings, press Exit. The settings you
have set so far will be saved. However, the Exit button is not enabled if it’s
the first time using this option.
Allows you to set Copy, Print, Send, Report priority or first in first out.
More Settings
You can set Job Progress Window, Job Deletion.
•
Job Progress Window: Allows you to show job progress in display.
•
Job Deletion: The Job Deletion setting specifies whether users can delete
all jobs or only the jobs that they create.
•
Language: Select the language to use on the display screen then tap Next.
•
Note: Read and tap Next.
•
Administrator Account: Input the Name, New Password, Confirm
Password.The admin is entered as a default in Name field.
•
Date & Time: Set the Date, Time, Time Zone, date and hour format, and
Day light Saving.
-Allow all jobs to delete: All users allow all jobs to delete.
-Allow only own jobs to delete: Users allow only own jobs to delete.
•
Home Screen Lock: Administrators can limit a user's ability to move/delete
widgets, apps, and shortcuts as well as use functions like Set Wallpaper or
Add to Home Screen.
Example for selecting the time zone, select your country area.
•
Device Attribution: Remove the existing device name and enter the device
name you want to use. then tap Next. Keep in mind to enter the device
name to be used on the network.
15
Initial settings (administrator only)
You can change the initial settings when you first turn the machine on.
• If necessary, enter the location of the machine in the Location field.
• If necessary, enter the information in the Administrator field for the
person to contact when any problem occurs on the machine.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
291
Admin Settings
•
Verify Connections: Tap the Test button to verify the Ethernet Card
connection. When Connected appears after tap the Test button, press
Next.
If Not connected appears, make sure that the machine is connected to the
network then verify the LAN connection again.
16
Fax Settings
You can set the default fax options. Set the most frequently used fax settings.
Tap Settings > Fax Settings from the display screen (see "General fax settings"
on page 139)
• If a network connection problem persists, contact your network
administrator.
• If the optional fax is not installed, the fax icon will not appear on the
display screen.
• If you installed an optional fax kit or finisher, press each Test button for
verify connection of them.
•
• The fax options are different from country to country depending on the
International Communications Regulatory. If some of the fax options
explained in the instructions have been grayed-out, it means that the
grayed-out option is not supported in your communication
environment.
Network Settings: Enter the IP address, Subnet Mask, Gateway, Host
Name, Domain Name, Primary DNS Server and Secondary DNS Server in
each field. Then tap Next.
• You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Settings tab >
Machine Settings > Fax (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
• If a new IP address is assigned automatically by a DHCP or BOOTP, press
DHCP or BOOTP.
• If you are not sure about your network environment, contact your
network administrator.
17
•
SNMP Configuration: Enter the Community Name, Access Permission,
Authentication User Name, Authentication Password, Authentication
Confirm Password, Privacy Password and Privacy Confirm Password in
each field. Then tap Done.
Print Settings
You can set print related settings. When there is no specific input for printing
options, the machine prints with the settings you set here. Set the frequently
used printing settings. This feature can be useful if your company has a specific
printing form.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
292
Admin Settings
Tap Settings > Print Settings from the display screen.
19
Report Settings
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click the Settings tab
> Machine Settings > Printer. (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
The paper source setting specifies the default paper tray that the machine uses
to print reports.
20
Application Management
18
Box Settings
You can store documents print,download and sent from computers or scanned
images in the Box. The Box is located on your machine’s hard disk drive (HDD).
It means the documents are stored on the HDD. You can create a password for a
certain Stored Document, so unauthorized users cannot access it. Also, you can
print stored documents by using a variety of printing features and send the
documents to several destination such as email, server or fax. You can set a
Stored Document and use Stored Document feature with SyncThru™ Web
Service.
You can install or uninstall applications/license. If you add an application, you
need to activate the license of the installed application. Some applications may
not have a license.
Tap Settings > Application Management from the home screen or Apps.
• You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click the
Maintenance tab > Application Management. (see "Application
Management" on page 293).
• Some models may not support this feature.
If important data is stored in the Box, we recommend you to backup the
data regularly. Samsung disclaims all responsibility for damage or loss of
data caused by misuse or failure of the machine.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
293
Admin Settings
Installing an application
1
2
3
Tap Install button.
A pop-up window with folders appear. Select the application file and
press OK.
Uninstalling an application
1
2
Select the application you want to uninstall and tap Uninstall.
A confirmation window appears. Press Yes.
The application you selected is uninstalled.
A verification message appears. Read the agreement and check I accept
terms of the License Agreement and press OK.
Application installation begins.
Viewing an application in details
1
2
Tap the application name you want to view in details.
View the application’s information in details.
Enabling/Disabling an application
1
Select the application you want to enable/disable and press Enable/
Disable.
2
The application you selected is enabled/disabled.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
294
Management
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine. When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Information >
Print information (see "Information tab" on page 161).
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
•
You can checking the supplies life and printing report.
System
-Configuration: Print to see the machine configuration information.
Product information, version information, product setting, and paper
setting are included.
Tap Settings > Management from the home screen or Apps.
-Supplies Information: Print to check remaining percentage of each
supply.
21
Supplies Life
-Usage Counter: Print to check the count of the jobs performed. Print
usage, scan usage, and fax usage information are included.
This feature allows you to check the remaining percentage of each supply.
-Demo Page: Print demo page to check if the machine is working properly.
You can also select A4 or letter.
ex) Toner cartridge / Imaging unit
-Error Information: Print to check what errors have occurred in the
machine. Error types and counts are included.
22
Report
-Network Configuration: Print to see the network configuration
information. Network configuration information such as TCP/IP, Raw
TCP/IP, and LPD information are printed.
This feature allows you to print all the reports provided by your machine. You
can use these reports to help you maintain your machine.
-Account: Print to see the account list.
•
Send:
-Send Confirmation: You can set the machine to print a report whether a
send was successfully completed or not.
-Fax Received: Print to check the list of faxes received.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
295
Management
-Fax Sent: Print to check the list of faxes sent.
-Fax Scheduled Jobs: Print to check the list of scheduled fax jobs.
-Email Sent: Print to check the transmission state of the Scan to Email job.
•
Font:
-PCL Font List: Print to see the PCL font list.
-PS Font List: Print to see the PS font list.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
296
Network Settings
This option is setting the Network Settings functions.
Feature
Description
Protocol
You can enable/disable IPv6 protocol.
• •Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your machine.
IPv6 Address
You can set the IPv6 address types.
• Click the
DHCPv6 Configuration
You can set the DHCPv6 configuration.
DHCP Unique Identifier
Show the DHCP Unique Identifiier.
802.1x
You can enable/disable 802.1x Security.
802.1x Authentication Method
You can select the authentication algorithm
to use.
DHCPv6 Identity Association
Identifier
Show the DHCP Identity Association
Identifier.
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
Tap Settings > Network Settings from the home screen or Apps.
23
Ethernet
Feature
Description
TCP/IPv4
Ethernet Port
You can enable/disable ethernet port.
Ethernet Speed
You can select the speed rate of ethernet.
MAC Address
Shows the Mac address of the machine.
-Static: Select to enter IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address manually.
IP Setting
You can set the TCP/IPv4 IP setting.
DNS Configuration
You can set the DNS setting.
-BOOTP: IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address are automatically
allocated by the BOOTP Server.
WINS
You can configure the WINS server.
Display IP Address
You can set the machine to display the IP
address on the Home screen.
You can set IPv4 settings.
•
IP Setting: You can choose the method for allocating IP addresses.
-DHCP: IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address are automatically
allocated by the DHCP Server.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
297
Network Settings
•
DNS Configuration: You can configure the DNS server.
TCP/IPv6
-Host Name: Enter the host name. You can enter up to 63 characters.
Default name is “SEC[MAC address]”.
You can set the IPv6 settings.
-Domain Name: Enter the domain name. You can enter up to 128
characters.
•
Protocol: Tap to use IPv6 protocol in the system. Reboot the machine to
apply the change.
-Primary DNS Server: Enter the address of the DNS server you want to use
primarily.
•
IPv6 Address: Shows the IPv6 address types.
-Link-local Address: This is an IPv6 address starting with a prefix value FE80.
This address has local link scope and is automatically generated.
-Secondary DNS Server: Enter the address of the DNS server you want to
use as an alternative.
-Stateless Address: This is an IPv6 address which is formed by router
advertised prefix and interface identifier. On a interface like Ethernet,
interface identifier is usually derived from the Mac address of the
machine. The advertised prefix depends on the router configurations.
-Dynamic DNS Registration: If you want to use, check the checkbox(es) of
dynamic DNS registration. If this option is checked, the machine
registers its host name and domain name to configured DNS servers
dynamically. Also, if this option is checked and DHCP is selected, DHCP
FQDN options are automatically disabled.
•
WINS: You can configure the WINS server. WINS is used in the Windows
operating system. Select this option.
•
Display IP Address: You can set the machine to display the IP address on
the Notification Bar. If you select this option the IP address will show on the
Notification Bar.
More than one address may be configured for the router advertisement, but
only one will be displayed in the display screen.
-Stateful Address: This is an IPv6 address which is acquired by a DHCPv6
server.
-Manual Address: This is an IPv6 address which an administrator can
configure manually.
•
DHCPv6 Configuration: Select the DHCPv6 configuration you want to us.
-Use DHCP as directed by a router: DHCPv6 is enabled when a router
advertises to use DHCPv6.
-Always Enable DHCP: Regardless of router advertisement, use DHCPv6 to
acquire an IPv6 address.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
298
Network Settings
-Never use DHCP: Disables DHCPv6.
•
DHCP Unique Identifier: Show the DHCP Unique ldentifier.
•
DHCP Identity Association Identifier: Show the DHCP Identity Association
Identifier.
802.1x
24
Wi-Fi
The Wi-Fi Menu is available only if the optional Wireless/NFC kit is installed.(see
"Wireless network setup (Optional)" on page 320).
The sub-menus in the Wi-Fi menu are nearly identical to the sub-menus in the
Ethernet menu (see "Ethernet" on page 297).
You can enable 802.1x authentication, which is a port-based authentication. If
this authentication is enabled, the machine is not allowed to access through the
protected side of the network until the machine is authorized. Use this feature
to protect your network.
•
802.1x : Check to enable this feature.
•
802.1x Authentication Method: Select the authentication algorithm to
use.
Feature
Wi-Fi Networks
After the machine connects to the wireless
network, the access point (router) SSID
appears on the display screen.
WPS Settings
If your machine and access point (or wireless
router) support Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS),
then you can easily configure the wireless
network settings through the WPS Settings
menu without the need for a computer.
Wi-Fi Direct
Wi-Fi Direct is a secure and easy-to-use peerto-peer connection between a Wi-Fi Directenabled printer and mobile device.
-EAP-MD5: Offers minimal security. The MD5 hash function is vulnerable to
dictionary attacks, and does not support key generation.
-PEAP: Recommended for users who only intend to use Microsoft desktop
clients and servers. For other users, it is not recommended.
-EAP-MS-CHAPv2: MS-CHAPv2 provides two-way authentication between
peers by combining a peer Challenge message with the Response
packet and an authenticator Response message on the Success packet.
-TLS: This is used to provide secure communication over the Internet
between a client and server.
Description
25
Network Protocol
You can enable/disable what you want network protocol
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
299
Network Settings
26
Network Security
You can enable and configure these options in SyncThru™ Web Service
only(see "Security tab" on page 163).
Feature
Description
IPSec
You can disable IPSec if it is turned on in
SyncThru™ Web Service.
Network Filtering
You can disable network filtering options if it
is turned on in SyncThru™ Web Service.
•
IPSec: You can disable IP security settings.
•
Network Filtering:
-MAC Filtering : Disable MAC filtering.
-IPv4 Filtering : Disable IPv4 filtering.
-IPv6 Filtering : Disable IPv6 filtering.
27
NFC
You can on/off NFC. The NFC feature is available when the optional Wireless/
NFC kit installed (see "Using the NFC feature (Optional)" on page 328).
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
300
System
• Some menus may not appear on the display depending on options or
models. If so, it is not applicable to your .
• Click the
(Help) from the home screen or
(quick menu) and
then click on any option you want to know about.
Machine Details
You can check the detailed machine information. Check the status of installed
hardware and software versions to help you maintain the machine. You can
download the latest software from the Samsung website (http://
www.samsung.com > find your product > Support or Downloads).
•
H/W Configuration: Shows the status of installed hardware including
optional parts.
•
Capabilities: Shows the capabilities of the hardware.
•
Software Versions: Shows the software versions of the systems installed.
28
Date and Time
When you set the time and date, it will be used for sending/printing delayed fax/
print jobs or will be printed on reports. However, if they are not correct, you need
to change it to the correct time.
30
Accessbility
29
About System
You can see the hardware configuration, system capabilities, and software
version of the machine.
Allows you to configure the machine to make it easier to use. In this menu, you
can change various sound, interaction, and display options so that the machine
is more accessible to users.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
301
System
31
Contact Information
This feature allows you to view the service center's information and contact
point where users can get help. If you log in as an administrator, you can change
the contact information.
•
System Administrator: Check the contact information of the administrator.
•
Samsung Support: Check the information of the service center.
2. Advanced Features for Settings Menu
302
3. Network Setup
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the network environment before using the machine. You
need to be familiar with the terms used for setting up the network environment. Refer to the glossary for terms you do
not understand ("Glossary" on page 366).
• Network environment
304
• Accessing network setup
305
• Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)
306
• Print settings (Ports to set for network printing)
309
• Set protocols
310
• Network filtering settings
311
• Installing driver over the network
312
• Wireless network setup (Optional)
320
• Using the NFC feature (Optional)
328
• Supported Mobile Apps
338
• AirPrint
340
• Google Cloud Print™
341
Network environment
You can use network after connecting network cable to a corresponding port on
your machine.
You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your
network machine. You can set up the basic network settings through the
machine's control panel.
Item
Network protocols
Specification
• TCP/IPv4
• DHCP, BOOTP
• DNS, WINS, Bonjour, SLP, UPnP
• Standard TCP/IP Printing (RAW), LPR, IPP
The following table shows the network environments supported by the
machine:
• FTP,SMB, SMTP, WSD
• LDAP, Kerberos, 802.1x
Item
Network interface
• TCP/IPv6 (DHCP, DNS, RAW, LPR, SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP,
IPSec)
• Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base-TX Wired Lan
• Network Interface 802.11b/g/n wireless LAN & Near
Field Communication(NFC)a
Network operating
system
• SNMPv 1/2/3, HTTP, IPSec
Specification
a. Optional device
• Windows® XP, Windows Server® 2003, Windows
Vista®, Windows® 7, Windows 8, Windows Server®
2008 R2
• Various Linux OS
• Various Unix OS
• Mac OS X 10.5 - 10.9
• Novell NetWare 5.x - 6.x
3. Network Setup
304
Accessing network setup
1
2
Make sure that the ethernet cable is connected to your machine.
3
Log-in as an administrator (see "Log-in" on page 280).
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Ethernet from the home screen or
Apps.
3. Network Setup
305
Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)
When you connect your machine to a network, you must first configure the TCP/
IP settings for the machine. The settings shown below are the basic settings
required for using your machine as a network machine. You can set TCP/IP, DNS
server, TCP/IPv6, Ethernet, and IP address allocation methods.
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Ethernet > TCP/IPv4 from the home
screen or Apps.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
1
Ethernet
You can set ethernet settings.
IP Setting
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Ethernet from the home screen or Apps.
You can choose the method for allocating IP addresses.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
•
Ethernet Port: You can enable/disable ethernet port.
•
Ethernet Speed: Choose the speed rate of ethernet.
•
MAC Address: Shows the Mac address of the machine.
•
Static: Select to enter IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address manually.
•
BOOTP: IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address are automatically
allocated by the BOOTP Server.
•
DHCP: IP address/Subnet Mask/ Gateway Address are automatically
allocated by the DHCP Server.
DNS Configuration
You can configure the DNS server.
2
TCP/IP Protocol
You can set IPv4 settings.
•
Host Name: Enter the host name. You can enter up to 63 characters. Default
name is “SEC[MAC address]”.
•
Domain Name: Enter the domain name. You can enter up to 128 characters.
3. Network Setup
306
Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)
•
•
•
Primary DNS Server: Enter the address of the DNS server you want to use
primarily.
Secondary DNS Server: Enter the address of the DNS server you want to
use as an alternative.
Dynamic DNS Registration: If you want to use, check the checkbox(es) of
dynamic DNS registration. If this option is checked, the machine registers its
host name and domain name to configured DNS servers dynamically. Also,
if this option is checked and DHCP is selected, DHCP FQDN options are
automatically disabled.
3
TCP/IPv6
You can set the IPv6 settings.
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Ethernet > TCP/IPv6 from the home
screen or Apps.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
WINS (Windows Internet Name Service)
•
Protocol: Tap to use IPv6 protocol in the system. Reboot the machine to
apply the change.
•
IPv6 Address: Shows the IPv6 address types.
You can configure the WINS server. WINS is used in the Windows operating
system. Select this option.
Display IP address
-Link-local Address: This is an IPv6 address starting with a prefix value FE80.
This address has local link scope and is automatically generated.
You can set the machine to display the IP address on the Notification Bar. If you
select this option the IP address will show on the Notification Bar.
-Stateless Address: This is an IPv6 address which is formed by router
advertised prefix and interface identifier. On a interface like Ethernet,
interface identifier is usually derived from the Mac address of the
machine. The advertised prefix depends on the router configurations.
More than one address may be configured for the router advertisement, but
only one will be displayed in the display screen.
3. Network Setup
307
Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)
•
•
•
-Stateful Address: This is an IPv6 address which is acquired by a DHCPv6
server.
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Ethernet > 802.1x from the home screen
or Apps.
-Manual Address: This is an IPv6 address which an administrator can
configure manually.
•
802.1x : Check to enable this feature.
•
DHCPv6 Configuration: Select the DHCPv6 configuration you want to us.
802.1x Authentication Method: Select the authentication algorithm to
use.
-Use DHCP as directed by a router: DHCPv6 is enabled when a router
advertises to use DHCPv6.
-EAP-MD5: Offers minimal security. The MD5 hash function is vulnerable to
dictionary attacks, and does not support key generation.
-Always Enable DHCP: Regardless of router advertisement, use DHCPv6 to
acquire an IPv6 address.
-PEAP: Recommended for users who only intend to use Microsoft desktop
clients and servers. For other users, it is not recommended.
-Never use DHCP: Disables DHCPv6.
-EAP-MS-CHAPv2: MS-CHAPv2 provides two-way authentication between
peers by combining a peer Challenge message with the Response
packet and an authenticator Response message on the Success packet.
DHCPv6 Unique Identifier: Clients use an DHCP Unique Identifier (DUID) to
obtain an IP address from the DHCPv6 server. The server looks up the DUID
in its database and delivers the appropriate configuration data (address,
lease times, DNS servers, etc.) to the client.
-TLS: This is used to provide secure communication over the Internet
between a client and server.
DHCPv6 Identity Association Identifier: Each interface has an ID, called an
Identity Association Identifier (IAID), that binds the interface to one or more
IP addresses. Each allocation in the DHCPv6 server includes a DUID and an
IAID pair.
4
802.1x
You can enable 802.1x authentication, which is a port-based authentication. If
this authentication is enabled, the machine is not allowed to access through the
protected side of the network until the machine is authorized. Use this feature
to protect your network.
3. Network Setup
308
Print settings (Ports to set for network printing)
You can set the ports to use when printing. If you want to print though the
network, you need to select the following ports.
Tap Settings > Management > Report > Network Configuration from the
home screen or Apps then tap Print.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)" on page 306).
3. Network Setup
309
Set protocols
You can enable/disable the protocols (Standard TCP/IP, LPR, IPP, ThinPrint,
CIFS, SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol), SLP (Service Location Protocol),
Telnet, SNMP V1/V2 (Simple Network Management Protocol), SNMPv3,
UPnP(SSDP) Protocol, and mDNS (Multicast Domain Name System), SetIP, and
HTTP).
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Network Protocol from the home screen
or Apps.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
3. Network Setup
310
Network filtering settings
You can set your machine to prevent unlisted IP or MAC addresses from
connecting to the machine.
You can set general network filtering settings.
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Network Security > Network Filtering
from the home screen or App.
You can also use this feature from the SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the
Web browser from your networked computer and type the IP address of
your machine (see "Settings tab" on page 162).
•
MAC Filtering : Disable MAC filtering.
•
IPv4 Filtering : Disable IPv4 filtering.
•
IPv6 Filtering : Disable IPv6 filtering.
3. Network Setup
311
Installing driver over the network
You must install the printer driver software for printing. The software includes
drivers, applications, and other support programs.
Make sure that the network setup for your machine is completed. All
applications should be closed on your computer before beginning installation.
5
Windows
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to the network and powered
on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set.
2
Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.
If the installation window does not appear, click Start > All programs >
Accessories > Run.
X:\Setup.exe replacing “X” with the letter, which represents your CDROM drive and click OK.
•For Windows 8,
If the installation window does not appear, from Charms, select
Search > Apps and search for Run. Type in X:\Setup.exe, replacing
“X” with the letter that represents your CD-ROM drive and click OK.
If “Tap to choose what happens with this disc.” pop-up window
appears, click the window and select Run Setup.exe.
3
Review and accept the installation agreements in the installation
window. Then, click Next.
3. Network Setup
312
Installing driver over the network
4
Select Network on the Printer Connection Type screen. Then, click
Next.
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to the network and powered
on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set.
5
Follow the instructions in the installation window.
2
3
From Charms, select Settings > Change PC settings > Devices.
From the Windows 8 Start Screen
• The V4 driver is automatically downloaded from the Windows Update if
your computer is connected to the Internet. If not, you can manually
download the V4 driver from Samsung website, www.samsung.com >
find your product > Support or downloads.
• You can download Samsung Printer Experience app from the Windows
Store. You need have a Microsoft account to use the Windows Store.
a From Charms, select Search.
b Click Store.
c Search and click Samsung Printer Experience.
d Click Install.
• If you install the driver using the supplied software CD, V4 driver is not
installed. If you want to use the V4 driver in the Desktop screen, you can
download from the Samsung website, www.samsung.com >find your
product > Support or downloads.
• If you want to install Samsung’s printer management tools, you need to
install them using the supplied software CD.
Click Add a device.
Discovered machines will be shown on the screen.
4
Click the model name or host name you wish to use.
You can print a Network Configuration Report from the machine’s control
panel that will show the current machine’s host name.
5
The driver is automatically installed from the Windows Update.
Silent installation Mode
Silent installation mode is an installation method that does not require any user
intervention. Once you start the installation, the machine driver and software
are automatically installed on your computer. You can start the silent installation
by typing /s or /S in the command window.
Command-line Parameters
Following table shows commands that can be used in the command window.
3. Network Setup
313
Installing driver over the network
Following command-line are effective and operated when command is
used with /s or /S. But /h, /H or /? are exceptional commands that can be
operated solely.
Command- line
/s or/S
Definition
Starts silent installation.
Description
Installs machine drivers
without prompting any UIs or
user intervention.
Command- line
Definition
/p”<port name>” or/ Specifies printer port.
P”<port name>”
Network Port will
be created by use
of Standard TCP/IP
Port monitor. For
local port, this port
must exist on
system before
being specified by
command.
Description
Printer port name can be
specified as IP address,
hostname, USB local port
name, IEEE1284 port name or
network path.
For example:
• /p”xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx” in
where, “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”
means IP address for
network printer. /
p”USB001”, /P”LPT1:”, /
p”hostname”
• /
p"\\computer_name\shar
ed_printer" or
"\\xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx\shared_
printer" in where,
"\\computer_name\share
d_printer" or
"\\xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx\shared_
printer" means the
network path to the
printer by entering two
slashes, the computer
name or local IP address of
the PC sharing the printer,
and then the share name
of the printer.
3. Network Setup
314
Installing driver over the network
Command- line
Definition
Description
/a”<dest_path>” or/
A”<dest_path>”
Specifies destination path
for installation.
Since machine drivers should
be installed on the OS
specific location, this
command applies to only
application software.
The destination
path should be a
fully qualified
path.
/n”<Printer name>”
or/N”<Printer
name>”
Specifies printer name.
Printer instance shall be
created as specified
printer name.
/nd or/ND
Commands not to set the It indicates installed machine
installed driver as a default driver will not be the default
machine driver.
machine driver on your
system if there are one or
more printer drivers installed.
If there is no installed
machine driver on your
system, then this option
won’t be applied because
Windows OS will set installed
printer driver as a default
machine driver.
Command- line
/x or/X
Definition
Uses existing machine
driver files to create
printer instance if it is
already installed.
Description
This command provides a
way to install a printer
instance that uses installed
printer driver files without
installing an additional
driver.
/up”<printer
Removes only specified
name>” or/
printer instance and not
UP”<printer name>” the driver files.
This command provides a
way to remove only specified
printer instance from your
system without effecting
other printer drivers. It will
not remove printer driver
files from your system.
/d or/D
This command will remove all
installed device drivers and
application software from
your system.
With this parameter, you can
add printer instances as your
wishes.
Uninstalls all device
drivers and applications
from your system.
/v”<share name>”
Shares installed machine
or/V”<share name>” and add other available
platform drivers for Point
& Print.
/o or /O
It will install all supported
Windows OS platform’s
machine drivers to system
and share it with specified
<share name> for point and
print.
Opens Printers and Faxes This command will open
folder after installation.
Printers and Faxes folder
after the silent installation.
3. Network Setup
315
Installing driver over the network
Command- line
/h, /H or /?
Definition
Description
Shows Command-line Usage.
7
8
Click Agree to agree to the license agreement.
Click Install. All components necessary for machine operations will be
installed.
If you click Customize, you can choose individual components to install.
6
Mac
1
2
3
Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered
on.
Insert the supplied software CD into your CD-ROM drive.
Enter the password and click OK (or Install Software).
11
Click Add Printer button to select your printer and add it to your printer
list.
12
13
14
Click IP and Select HP Jetdirect - Socket in Protocol.
15
if Auto Select does not work properly, choose Select Printer Software and
your machine name in Print Using.
16
17
18
Click Add.
Select Network Connected Printer(Wired or Wireless) on the Printer
Connection Type and click Continue.
Enter the machine’s IP address in the Address input field.
Enter the queue name in the Queue input field. If you cannot determine
the queue name for your machine server, try using the default queue
first.
Double-click the CD-ROM icon that appears on your Mac desktop.
•For Mac OS X 10.8, Double-click the CD-ROM that appears on Finder.
4
5
6
9
10
Double-click the MAC_Installer folder > Installer OS X icon.
Click Continue.
Read the license agreement and click Continue.
Click Continue.
After the installation is finished, click Close.
3. Network Setup
316
Installing driver over the network
10
11
7
Linux
You need to download Linux software packages from the Samsung website to
install the printer software (http://www.samsung.com > find your product >
Support or Downloads).
Select AppSocket/HP JetDirect and enter your machine’s IP address.
Click Forward button and add it to your system.
8
UNIX
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your network and powered
on. Also, your machine’s IP address should have been set.
2
3
Copy Unified Linux Driver package to your system.
• The commands are marked with “”, when typing the commands, do not
type “”.
Open Terminal program and go to the folder that you copied
thepackage to.
• Some features and optional goods may not be available depending on
model or country (see "Operating System" on page 8).
4
5
6
Extract the package.
7
8
Proceed with installation.
9
Click Add button.
Move to uld folder.
Execute ” ./install.sh“ command (If you are not logged in as root,execute
the command with “sudo” as “sudo ./install.sh”).
When installation finished, launch Printing utility (Go to System >
Administration > Printing or execute “system-config-printer“
command in Terminal program).
• Make sure your machine supports the UNIX operating system before
installing the UNIX printer driver (see "Operating System" on page 8).
To use the UNIX printer driver, you have to install the UNIX printer driver
package first, then setup the printer. You can download the UNIX printer driver
package from the Samsung website (http://www.samsung.com > find your
product > Support or Downloads).
Installing the UNIX printer driver package
The installation procedure is common for all variants of UNIX OS mentioned.
3. Network Setup
317
Installing driver over the network
1
From the Samsung website, download and unpack the UNIX Printer
Driver package to your computer.
2
Acquire root privileges.
“su -”
3
Copy the appropriate driver archive to the target UNIX computer.
8
Run “installprinter” from the command line. This will bring up the Add
Printer Wizard window. Setup the printer in this window referring to
the following procedures.
On some UNIX OS, for example on Solaris 10, just added printers may not be
enabled and/or may not accept jobs. In this case run the following two
commands on the root terminal:
“accept <printer_name>”
See administration guide of your UNIX OS for details.
4
“enable <printer_name>”
Unpack the UNIX printer driver package.
For example, on IBM AIX, use the following commands.
Uninstalling the printer driver package
“gzip -d < enter the package name | tar xf -”
5
6
the unpacked directory.
Run the install script.
“./install –i”
install is the installer script file which is used to install or uninstall the
UNIX Printer Driver package.
Use “chmod 755 install” command to give the permission to the
installer script.
7
Execute the “. /install –c” command to verify installation results.
The utility should be used to delete the printer installed in the system.
a Run “uninstallprinter” command from the terminal.
It will open the Uninstall Printer Wizard.
The installed printers are listed in the drop-down list.
b Select the printer to be deleted.
c Click Delete to delete the printer from the system.
d Execute the “. /install –d” command to uninstall the whole package.
e To verify removal results, execute the “. /install –c” command.
To re-install it, use the command “. /install –i” to reinstall the binaries.
3. Network Setup
318
Installing driver over the network
Setting up the printer
To add the printer to your UNIX system, run ‘installprinter’ from the command
line. This will bring up the Add Printer Wizard window. Setup the printer in this
window according to the following steps:
1
2
3
Type the name of the printer.
4
5
6
Specify any printer description in the Description field. This is optional.
7
8
9
10
11
12
Check the Make Default option to set this printer as default.
Click OK to add the printer.
Select the appropriate printer model from the model list.
Enter any description corresponding to the type of the printer in the
Type field. This is optional.
Specify the printer location in the Location field.
Type the IP address or DNS name of the printer in the Device textbox for
network-connected printers. On IBM AIX with jetdirect Queue type,
only the DNS name is possible-numeric IP address is not allowed.
Queue type shows the connection as lpd or jetdirect in the
corresponding list box. Additionally, usb type is available on Sun Solaris
OS.
Select Copies to set the number of copies.
Check the Collate option to receive copies already sorted.
Check the Reverse Order option to receive copies in the reverse order.
3. Network Setup
319
Wireless network setup (Optional)
9
• If you want to add wireless feature to the machine, check the option lists
and contact the purchasing point to order (see "Available accessories" on
page 235). When you purchase a Wireless/NFC kit (Wireless LAN Option),
install the kit by following the steps described in the Wireless Kit
(Wireless LAN Option) Guide which is enclosed in the kit. After installing
the Wireless Kit (Wireless LAN Option), set the machine to use this
feature.
• Make sure your machine supports wireless networking. Wireless
networking may not be available depending on the model (see "Features
by model" on page 8).
Wireless networks require higher security, so when an access point is first set up,
a network name (SSID), the type of security used, and a Network Password are
created for the network. Ask your network administrator about this information
before proceeding with the machine installation.
Introducing wireless set up methods
You can set wireless settings either from the machine or the computer. Choose
the setting method from the below table.
• Some wireless network installation types may not be available
depending on the model or country.
• It is strongly recommended that you set the password on Access Points.
If you do not set the password on Access Points, they might be exposed
to illegal access from unknown machines including PCs, smart phones
and printers. Refer to the Access Point user' guide for password settings.
Set up method
With Access
Point
Connecting method
Description & Reference
From the computer
See "Using a network cable" on page
323.
From the machine’s
control panel
See "Using the WPS Settings menu" on
page 321.
See "Using the Wi-Fi Networks" on
page 323.
Wi-Fi Direct setup
See "Setting the Wi-Fi Direct for mobile
printing" on page 325.
3. Network Setup
320
Wireless network setup (Optional)
Choosing your type
10
Using the WPS Settings menu
There are two methods available to connect your machine to a wireless network.
If your machine and access point (or wireless router) support Wi-Fi Protected
Setup™ (WPS), then you can easily configure the wireless network settings
through the WPS Settings menu without the need for a computer.
• If you want to use the wireless network using the infrastructure mode,
make sure that the network cable is disconnected from the machine.
Using the WPS (PBC) button or entering the PIN from the computer to
connect to the access point (or wireless router) varies depending on the
access point (or wireless router) you are using. Refer to the user's guide
of the access point (or wireless router) you are using.
•
The Push Button Configuration (PBC) method allows you to connect your
machine to a wireless network by pressing both the WPS Settings menu on
the control panel of your machine and the WPS (PBC) button on a Wi-Fi
Protected Setup™ WPS-enabled access point (or wireless router)
respectively.
•
The Personal Identification Number (PIN) method helps you connect your
machine to a wireless network by entering the supplied PIN information on
a Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ WPS-enabled access point (or wireless router).
• When using the WPS button to set the wireless network, security settings
may change. To prevent this, lock the WPS option for the current wireless
security settings. The option name may differ depending on the access
point (or wireless router) you are using.
Items to prepare
•
Check if the access point (or wireless router) supports Wi-Fi Protected
Setup™ (WPS).
•
Check if your machine supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS).
•
Networked computer (PIN mode only)
3. Network Setup
321
Wireless network setup (Optional)
Connecting WPS
Factory default in your machine is PBC mode, which is recommended for a
typical wireless network environment.
Connecting in PIN mode
1
2
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
Connecting in PBC mode
1
2
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Wi-Fi from the home screen or App.
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Wi-Fi from the home screen or App.
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
3
4
5
Tap WPS Settings > Connect via PBC.
Press the WPS (PBC) button on the access point (or wireless router).
3
4
Tap WPS Settings > Connect via PIN.
The eight-digit PIN appears on the display.
You need to enter the eight-digit PIN within two minutes on the
computer that is connected to the access point (or wireless router).
5
Follow the instruction on the display screen.
The messages are displayed on the display screen
Follow the instruction on the display screen.
The messages are displayed on the display screen
3. Network Setup
322
Wireless network setup (Optional)
Items to prepare
11
Using the Wi-Fi Networks
Before starting, you will need to know the network name (SSID) of your wireless
network and the network key if it is encrypted. This information was set when
the access point (or wireless router) was installed. If you do not know about your
wireless environment, please ask the person who set up your network.
1
2
3
•
Access point
•
Network-connected computer
•
Software CD that was provided with your machine
•
A machine installed with a wireless network interface
•
Network cable
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Wi-Fi from the home screen or App.
The machine will display a list of available networks from which to
choose. After a network is chosen then printer will prompt for the
corresponding security key.
Select the Wi-Fi network option you want.
Printing a network configuration report
You can identify the network settings of your machine by printing a network
configuration report.
See "Report" on page 295.
12
Using a network cable
See your network administrator, or the person that set up your wireless
network, for information about your network configuration.
Your machine is a network compatible machine. To enable your machine to
work with your network, you will need to perform some configuration
procedures.
IP setting using SetIP Program (Windows)
This program is used to manually set the network IP address of your machine
using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. The MAC address is
the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the
Network Configuration Report.
See "Network settings (configuring TCP/IP)" on page 306.
3. Network Setup
323
Wireless network setup (Optional)
Configuring the machine’s wireless network
Before starting you will need to know the network name (SSID) of your wireless
network and the network key if it is encrypted. This information was set when
the access point (or wireless router) was installed. If you do not know about your
wireless environment, please ask the person who set up your network.
To configure wireless parameters, you can use SyncThru™ Web Service.
5
When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network
Settings.
6
7
8
Click Wi-Fi > Wizard.
Select the one Network Name(SSID) in the list.
Click Next.
If the wireless security setting window appears, enter the registered
password (network password) and click Next.
Using SyncThru™ Web Service
9
Before starting wireless parameter configuration, check the cable connection
status.
The confirmation window appears, please check your wireless setup. If
the setup is right, click Apply.
13
1
Check whether or not the network cable is connected to the machine. If
not, connect the machine with a standard network cable.
Turning the Wi-Fi network on/off
2
Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari, or Firefox and enter
your machine’s new IP address in the browser window.
1
Check whether the network cable is connected to the machine. If not,
connect the machine with a standard network cable.
2
Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari, or Firefox and enter
your machine’s new IP address in the browser window.
For example,
3
4
For example,
Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
3
Click Login on the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.
3. Network Setup
324
Wireless network setup (Optional)
4
Type in the ID and Password.
• You cannot connect your mobile device to the internet through the
printer’s Wi-Fi Direct.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
• The supported protocol list may differ from your model, Wi-Fi Direct
networks do NOT support IPv6, network filtering, IPSec, WINS, and SLP
services.
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
5
6
7
When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Network
Settings.
• The maximum number of devices that can be connected via Wi-Fi Direct
is 4.
Setting up Wi-Fi Direct
Click Wi-Fi.
You can enable Wi-Fi Direct feature by one of the following methods.
You can turn the Wi-Fi network on/off.
From the machine
14
Setting the Wi-Fi Direct for mobile printing
Wi-Fi Direct is a secure and easy-to-use peer-to-peer connection between a WiFi Direct-enabled printer and mobile device.
1
2
Tap Settings > Network Settings > Wi-Fi from the home screen or App.
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
With Wi-Fi Direct, you can connect your printer to a Wi-Fi Direct network while
concurrently connecting to an access point. You can also use a wired network
and a Wi-Fi Direct network simultaneously so multiple users can access and print
documents both from Wi-Fi Direct and from a wired network.
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
3
Tap Wi-Fi Direct.
3. Network Setup
325
Wireless network setup (Optional)
4
Enable Wi-Fi Direct.
15
Troubleshooting for wireless network
From the network-connected computer
If your printer is using a network cable or a wireless access point, you can enable
and configure Wi-Fi Direct from SyncThru™ Web Service.
1
Access SyncThru™ Web Service and select Settings > Network
Settings > Wi-Fi > Wi-Fi Direct™.
2
Enable Wi-Fi Direct™ and set other options.
Setting up the mobile device
If problems occur while using the machine on a network, check the following:
For information on the access point (or wireless router), refer to its own
user's guide.
•
Your computer, access point (or wireless router), or machine may not be
turned on.
•
Check the wireless reception around the machine. If the router is far from
the machine or there is an obstacle, you might have difficulty receiving the
signal.
•
After setting up Wi-Fi Direct from the printer, refer to the user manual of the
mobile device you are using to set its Wi-Fi Direct.
•
•
After setting up Wi-Fi Direct, you need to download the mobile printing
application (For example: Samsung Mobile printer) to print from your
smartphone.
Cycle the power for the access point (or wireless router), machine, and
computer. Sometimes cycling the power can recover network
communication.
•
Check whether firewall software (V3 or Norton) is blocking the
communication.
If the computer and the machine are connected on the same network and it
cannot be found when searching, firewall software might be blocking the
communication. Refer to the user's guide for the software to turn it off and
try searching for the machine again.
• When you have found the printer you want to connect to from your
mobile device, select the printer and the printer's LED will blink. Press the
WPS button on the printer and it will be connected to your mobile
device.
• If your mobile device does not support Wi-Fi Direct, you need to enter
the "Network Key" of a printer instead of pushing the WPS button.
•
Check whether the machine's IP address is allocated correctly. You can
check the IP address by printing the network configuration report.
3. Network Setup
326
Wireless network setup (Optional)
•
•
Check whether the access point (or wireless router) has a configured
security (password). If it has a password, refer to the access point (or wireless
router) administrator.
Check the machine's IP address. Reinstall the machine driver and change the
settings to connect to the machine on the network. Due to the
characteristics of DHCP, the allocated IP address could change if the
machine is not used for a long time or if the access point has been reset.
Register the product's MAC address when you configure the DHCP server on
the access point (or wireless router). Then you can always use the IP address
that is set with the MAC address. You can identify the Mac address of your
machine by printing a network configuration report.
•
Check the wireless environment. You might not be able to connect to the
network in the infrastructure environment where you need to type in a
user's information before connecting to the access point (or wireless router).
•
This machine only supports IEEE 802.11 b/g/n and Wi-Fi. Other wireless
communication types (e.g., Bluetooth) are not supported.
•
The machine is within the range of the wireless network.
•
The machine is located away from obstacles that could block the wireless
signal.
•
The machine is located away from other electronic devices that may
interfere with the wireless signal.
Many devices can interfere with the wireless signal, including a microwave
oven and some Bluetooth devices.
•
Whenever the configuration of your access point (or wireless router)
changes, you must do the product's wireless network setup again.
•
The maximum number of devices that can be connected via Wi-Fi Direct is 4.
Remove any large metal objects between the access point (or wireless
router) and the machine.
Make sure the machine and wireless access point (or wireless router) are not
separated by poles, walls, or support columns containing metal or concrete.
3. Network Setup
327
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
16
If you want to add NFC feature to the machine, check the option lists and
contact the purchasing point to order (see "Available accessories" on page
235). When you purchase a Wireless/NFC Kit (Wireless LAN Option), install
the kit by following the steps described in the Wireless/NFC Kit (Wireless
LAN Option) Guide which is enclosed in the kit. After installing the Wireless
Kit (Wireless LAN Option), set the machine to use this feature.
The NFC (Near Field Communication) printer allows you to directly print from
your mobile device just by holding your mobile device over the NFC tag on
Wireless/NFC Kit (Wireless LAN Option). It does not require installing print driver
or connecting to an access point. You just need NFC supported mobile device.
In order to use this feature, mobile apps needs to be installed on your mobile
device.
Requirements
•
NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled, supported mobile apps installed mobile
device with Android OS 4.0 or higher.
Only Android OS 4.1 or higher will automatically enable the Wi-Fi Direct
feature on your mobile device when you enable the NFC feature. We
recommend you to upgrade your mobile device to Android OS 4.1 or higher
to use the NFC feature.
•
Wi-Fi Direct feature enabled printer (see "Setting the Wi-Fi Direct for mobile
printing" on page 325).
17
• Depending on the material of the mobile device cover, NFC recognition
may not work properly.
• Depending on the mobile device you are using, the transmission speed
may differ.
• This feature is available only for the model with a NFC tag (see "Machine
overview" on page 20).
Related Apps
There are some apps that can be used with the NFC feature. The apps can be
downloaded from the Google Play Store.
•
Samsung Mobile Print: Enables users to print, scan(Only users with the
machine supports scan), or fax(Only users with the machine supports fax)
photos, documents, and web pages directly from your smartphone or tablet
(see "Using the Samsung Mobile Print App" on page 334).
•
Samsung Mobile Print Pro: Helps users to get an authentication easily. This
app provides one way of getting a user authentication using your mobile
device (see "Using the Samsung Mobile Print Pro App" on page 329).
• Using a cover or a battery other than the ones that came with the mobile
device, or a metal cover/sticker can block NFC.
• If NFC devices keep failing to communicate,
-Remove the case or cover from the mobile device, then try again.
-Reinstall the battery from the mobile device, then try again.
3. Network Setup
328
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
•
Samsung Mobile Print Manager: Enables users to use cloning and wireless
setup features using your mobile device (see "Using the Samsung Mobile
Print Manager App" on page 331).
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
18
Using the Samsung Mobile Print Pro App
You can use it to get an authentication/registration from the Samsung Mobile
Print Pro app.
4
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to connect to the printer.
Authentication from the mobile device
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled features are on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print Pro app.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print Pro installed on your cellphone,
go to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store, App Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same admin ID, Password as when logging in from the machine
(see "Log-in" on page 280.)
3. Network Setup
329
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
Registration from the mobile device
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled features are on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print Pro app.
• If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security
tab" on page 163.
• Passcode is for when the administrator chooses Two-Factor
Authentication method. You need to enter a passcode for
authentication. Password and passcode should be different. You can
select Two-Factor Authentication from the SyncThru™ Web Service,
select Security > User Access Control > Authentication >
Authentication Method > Options button > Login Method > TwoFactor Authentication.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print Pro installed on your cellphone,
go to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store) on your mobile
device, and just search for download the app and try again.
7
3
4
5
Press the
icon on the Samsung Mobile Print Pro screen.
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to connect to the printer.
Select On from the Phone login set as default menu.
Mobile device ID appears on the Samsung Mobile Print Pro screen.
Press Registration.
6
Type in the ID , Password, Domain, and Passcode, then click OK.
Use the same admin ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
3. Network Setup
330
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
8
Registration complete message appears on the printer’s touch screen.
19
Using the Samsung Mobile Print Manager App
If you have more than one printer and need to set the same settings on each
printer, you can easily do it using the Samsung Mobile Print Manager app.
Touch your cellphone on the NFC tag on your printer to copy the settings and
tap on the printer you want to set the setting.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print Manager installed on your
cellphone, go to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
4
Press Export.
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same admin ID, Password as when logging in from the machine
(see "Log-in" on page 280.)
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
When exporting the data, you can save more than one data. When
importing the data, you can select the data from the list and import.
Exporting(Copying the setting to your mobile
device)
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled features are on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print Manager from your mobile device.
3. Network Setup
331
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
5
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to connect to the printer.
Importing (Applying the settings to the machine)
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled features are on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print Manager from your mobile device.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print Manager installed on your
cellphone, go to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
4
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same admin ID, Password as when logging in from the machine
(see "Log-in" on page 280.)
• For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
• While cloning, the machine is locked.
6
7
Press Import.
Select the settings you want to apply and press OK.
Follow the instruction on the mobile device’s screen.
5
6
Select the settings you want to copy.
Follow the instruction on the mobile device’s screen.
3. Network Setup
332
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
7
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to connect to the printer.
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled features are on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print Manager from your mobile device.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print Manager installed on your
cellphone, go to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
Mobile device Samsung Mobile Print Pro screen appears.
Press Wi-Fi Setup.
4
Type in the ID and Password.
Use the same admin ID, Password as when logging in from the machine
(see "Log-in" on page 280.)
• For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
If you want to create a new user or change the password, see "Security tab"
on page 163.
• While cloning, the machine is locked.
Wireless Setup
You can copy wireless setting from your phone to your printer by touching your
mobile device on the NFC tag on your printer.
5
If the access point (or wireless router) is connected to the connection
confirmation window appears, then click OK.If the access point (or
wireless router) not connection, select the desired access point (or
wireless router) and click OK, then click OK.
3. Network Setup
333
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
6
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
20
Using the Samsung Mobile Print App
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to connect to the printer.
Samsung Mobile Print is a free application that enables users to print,
scan(Only users with multi-functional printers), or fax(Only users with multifunctional printers) photos, documents, and web pages directly from your
smartphone or tablet.
Printing
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct features are enabled on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print app.
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
7
Follow the instruction on the mobile device’s screen.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print installed on your cellphone, go
to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store, App Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
4
Select print mode.
Select the content you want to print.
If necessary, change the print option by pressing the
icon.
3. Network Setup
334
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
5
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait a few seconds for the mobile device to send a job to the printer.
Scanning
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct features are enabled on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print app.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print installed on your cellphone, go
to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store, App Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
4
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
6
Select scan mode.
Place a single document face down on the document glass, or load the
documents face up into the document feeder (see "Loading originals" on
page 45).
If necessary, change the scan option by pressing the
.
The printer starts printing.
3. Network Setup
335
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
5
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to send a job to the printer.
Sending Fax
1
Check that NFC and Wi-Fi Direct features are enabled on your mobile
device and Wi-Fi Direct feature is enabled on your printer.
2
Open Samsung Mobile Print app.
If you do not have Samsung Mobile Print installed on your cellphone, go
to the application store (Samsung Apps, Play Store, App Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for download the app and try again.
3
4
Select fax mode.
Select the content you want to send fax.
If necessary, enter the fax number and change the fax option by pressing
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
6
the
icon.
The printer starts scanning the content.
The scanned data is saved on your mobile device.
If you want to continue scanning, follow the instruction on the app screen.
3. Network Setup
336
Using the NFC feature (Optional)
5
Tag your mobile device (usually located on the back of the mobile
device) over the NFC tag (
) on your printer.
Wait few seconds for the mobile device to send a job to the printer.
For some mobile devices, NFC tag might not be located at the back of the
mobile device. Check the location of the NFC antenna on your mobile
device before tagging.
6
The printer starts faxing the content.
3. Network Setup
337
Supported Mobile Apps
21
22
Available Apps
•
•
•
Samsung Mobile Print: Samsung Mobile Print is a free application that
enables users to print, scan(Only users with the machine supports scan), or
fax(Only users with the machine supports fax) photos, documents, and web
pages directly from your smartphone or tablet. Samsung Mobile Print is
not only compatible with your Android and iOS smart phones but also with
your iPod Touch and tablet PC. It connects your mobile device to a network
connected Samsung printer or to a wireless printer through a Wi-Fi access
point. Installing a new driver or configuring network settings isn’t necessary
– just simply install the Samsung Mobile Print application, and it will
automatically detect compatible Samsung printers. Besides printing photos,
web pages, and PDFs, scanning is also supported. If you have a Samsung
multifunction, scan any document into a JPG, PDF, or PNG format for quick
and easy viewing on your mobile device (see "Using the Samsung Mobile
Print App" on page 334).
Samsung Mobile Print Pro: Helps users to get an authentication easily. This
app provides one way of getting a user authentication using your mobile
device (see "Using the Samsung Mobile Print Pro App" on page 329).
Samusng Mobile Print Manager: Enables users to use cloning and wireless
setup features using your mobile device (see "Using the Samsung Mobile
Print Manager App" on page 331).
Downloading Apps
To download apps, go to the application store (Play Store, App Store) on your
mobile device, and just search for “Samsung Mobile Print /Samsung Mobile
Print Pro/Samusng Mobile Print Manager.” You can also visit iTunes for Apple
devices on your computer.
•
Samsung Mobile Print
-Android: Search for Samsung Mobile Print from Play Store, and then
download the app.
-iOS: Search for Samsung Mobile Print from App Store, and then download
the app.
•
Samsung Mobile Print Pro/Samusng Mobile Print Manager
-Android: Search for Samsung Mobile Print Pro or Samusng Mobile Print
Manager from Play Store, and then download the app.
23
Supported Mobile OS
•
Samsung Mobile Print
-Android OS 2.3 or higher
-iOS 5.0 or higher
3. Network Setup
338
Supported Mobile Apps
•
Samsung Mobile Print Pro/Samusng Mobile Print Manager
-NFC and Wi-Fi Direct enabled, supported mobile apps installed mobile
device with Android 4.0 or higher
3. Network Setup
339
AirPrint
4
Only AirPrint certified machines can use the AirPrint feature. Check the box
your machine came in for the AirPrint certified mark.
Type in the ID and Password and select the Domain. Then click on
LOGIN.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
AirPrint allows you to print directly from iPhone, iPad and iPod touch
running the latest version of iOS.
5
When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Settings >
Network Settings.
6
Click AirPrint.
24
Setting up AirPrint
25
Printing via AirPrint
Bonjour(mDNS) and IPP protocols are required on your machine to use the
AirPrint feature. You can enable the AirPrint feature by one of the following
methods.
1
2
Check whether the machine is connected to the network.
Start a web browser such as Internet Explorer, Safari, or Firefox and enter
your machine’s new IP address in the browser window.
For example,
3
Click Login in the upper right of the SyncThru™ Web Service website.
For example, the iPad manual provides these instructions:
1
2
3
4
Open your email, photo, web page, or document you want to print.
Touch the action icon(
).
Select your printer driver name and option menu to set up.
Touch Print button. Print it out.
Cancelling print job: To cancel the printing job or view the print summary,
click the print center icon (
) in multitasking area. You can click cancel in
the print center.
3. Network Setup
340
Google Cloud Print™
Google Cloud Print™ is a service that allows you to print to a printer using your
smart phone, tablet, or any other web-connected devices. Just register your
Google account with the printer, and you are ready to use the Google Cloud
Print™ service. You can print your document or email with Chrome OS, Chrome
browser, or a Gmail™/ Google Docs™ application on your mobile device, so you
don’t need to install the printer driver on the mobile device. Refer to the Google
website (http://google.com/cloudprint/learn/ or http://support.google.com/
cloudprint) for more information about Google Cloud Print™.
5
Click Login in the upper right corner of the SyncThru™ Web Service
website.
6
Type in the ID and Password and select the Domain. Then click on
LOGIN.
Use the same login ID, Password, Domain as when logging in from the
machine (see "Log-in" on page 280.)
If the network environment is using a proxy server, you need to configure
the proxy’s IP and port number from Settings > Network Settings >
Google Cloud Print > Proxy Setting. Contact your network service
provider or network administrator for more information.
26
Registering your Google account to the printer
Registering from the Chrome Browser
• Make sure the printer machine is turned on and connected to a wired or
wireless network that has access to the Internet.
• You should create your Google account in the advance.
7
When the SyncThru™ Web Service window opens, click Settings >
Network Settings > Google Cloud Print.
8
9
Enter your printer’s name and description.
Click Register.
The confirmation pop-up window appears.
1
2
3
4
Open the Chrome browser.
If you set the browser to block pop-ups, the confirmation window will not
appear. Allow the site to show pop-ups.
Visit www.google.com.
Sign in to the Google website with your Gmail™ address.
Enter your printer’s IP address in the address field and press the Enter key
or click Go.
10
Click Finish printer registration.
3. Network Setup
341
Google Cloud Print™
11
Click Manage your printers.
Now your printer is registered with Google Cloud Print™ service.
Google Cloud Print™-ready devices will appear in the list.
27
Printing with Google Cloud Print™
The printing procedure varies depending on the application or the device you
are using. You can see the application list that supports Google Cloud Print™
service.
2
3
4
5
6
7
Access the Google Docs™ application from your mobile device.
Tap the option
Tap the send
button of the document that you want to print.
button.
Tap the Cloud Print
button.
Set the printing options if you want.
Tap Click here to Print.
Printing from the Chrome browser
Make sure the printer is turned on and connected to a wired or wireless
network that has access to the Internet.
Printing from an application on mobile device
The following steps are an example of using the Google Docs™ app from
Android mobile phone.
1
Install the Cloud Print application on your mobile device.
If you do not have the application, download it from the application store
such as Android Market or App Store.
The following steps are an example of using the Chrome browser.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Run Chrome.
Open the document or email that you want to print.
Click the wrench icon
in the browser’s top right corner.
Click Print. A new tab for printing appears.
Select Print with Google Cloud Print.
Click the Print button.
3. Network Setup
342
4. Maintenance
This chapter provides information for maintaining your machine.
This chapter includes:
• Monitoring the supplies life
344
• Setting supplies reorder notification
345
• Replacing & redistributing supplies
346
• Finding the serial number
347
• Clearing memory
348
• Cleaning the machine
349
• Tips for storing machine, supplies, and paper
355
• Tips for moving the machine
356
• Printing a demo page
357
Monitoring the supplies life
Check remaining life of the supplies and prepare the supplies in advance.
You can also print the supplies life report. Select Supplies Information in the
Report feature (see "Report" on page 295, "Information tab" on page 161).
We recommend you prepare new supplies if the remaining percentage is
less than 10 % (see "Replacing & redistributing supplies" on page 346).
1
From the machine
1
2
Tap Settings > Management > Supplies Life from the main screen.
Check the consumables life.
We recommend you prepare new supplies or those that you have used over
90 % of their average yield (see "Replacing & redistributing supplies" on
page 346).
2
From the SyncThru™ Web Service
1
From the SyncThru™ Web Service, select the Information tab >
Supplies.
2
Check the remaining percentage.
4. Maintenance
344
Setting supplies reorder notification
Set the supplies reorder notification to receive notification emails and prepare
supplies in advance.
See "Supplies Management" on page 290.
4. Maintenance
345
Replacing & redistributing supplies
3
Replacing the toner cartridge
At this stage, the imaging unit needs to be replaced. Be sure to prepare a new
imaging unit in advance (see "Ordering supplies and accessories" on page 233).
How to replace the imaging unit (see "Replacing the imaging unit" on page 189).
When the toner cartridge is totally empty:
5
•
The status LED turns red on and the display screen shows the error message
of replacing toner.
•
The machine stops printing and incoming faxes are saved in memory.
However, when the toner cartridge is empty, but you can still print blackand-white print jobs (The submitted job must be in black and white).
•
Check the type of the toner cartridge for your machine (see "Ordering
supplies and accessories" on page 233).
At this stage, the toner cartridge needs to be replaced. Be sure to prepare new
toner cartridge in advance (see "Ordering supplies and accessories" on page
233). How to replace the toner cartridge (see "Replacing the toner cartridge" on
page 187).
Redistributing toner
When the toner cartridge is near the end of its life:
•
White streaks or light printing occurs.
•
Toner low related message appears on the display.
•
The Status LED blinks red.
If this happens, you can temporarily improve print quality by redistributing the
remaining toner in the cartridge. In some cases, white streaks or light printing
will still occur even after you have redistributed the toner. How to redistribute
the toner (see "Redistributing toner" on page 185).
4
Replacing the imaging unit
When the imaging unit is totally empty:
•
The status LED turns red on and the display screen shows the error message
of replacing imaging unit.
•
Check the type of the imaging unit for your machine ("Ordering supplies and
accessories" on page 233).
4. Maintenance
346
Finding the serial number
You might need to know the serial number of your machine when calling for a
service. To check the serial number of your machine, follow the steps below.
The serial number is written on the beginning of all the machine reports.
1
Tap Settings > Management > Report > Usage Counter > Print from
the home screen or Apps.
OR
Select the Information tab > Usage Counters from the SyncThru™ Web
Service.
2
Check the serial number.
4. Maintenance
347
Clearing memory
There are few ways to clear memory to ensure the memory capacity of your
machine. Select one of the ways below.
Clearing fax memory without printing a fax job
If you clear fax memory without checking the fax job by printing it first, you
might erase jobs that you do not want to. Be careful not to erase important
documents.
6
Clearing stored documents
Check the stored documents before clearing machine memory.
1
2
3
Tap Box from the main screen.
Touch and hold folder or document you want to erase from the list.
Tap
> Delete.
1
2
3
Tap Job Status from the home screen or Apps.
Select the Current Job tab from the display screen.
Select the job(s) you want to erase than press Delete.
If you want to erase all the jobs, press Delete All.
To erase only fax jobs on the list, select fax jobs with in the Job Type list and click
Delete.
7
Clearing fax memory
When the fax memory is full, you can erase stored fax memory. There are two
ways to erase the fax memory, follow the steps below:
Clearing fax memory by printing a fax job
Print received fax(es). Fax memory will automatically be erased.
4. Maintenance
348
Cleaning the machine
If printing quality problems occur or if you use your machine in a dusty environment, you need to clean your machine regularly to keep it in the best printing
condition and use your machine longer.
• Cleaning the cabinet of the machine with cleaning materials containing large amounts of alcohol, solvents, or other strong substances can discolor or distort the
cabinet.
• If your machine or the surrounding area is contaminated with toner, we recommend you use a cloth or tissue dampened with water to clean it. If you use a vacuum
cleaner, toner blows in the air and might be harmful to you.
8
Cleaning the outside
Clean the machine cabinet with a soft, lint-free cloth. Dampen the cloth slightly with water, but be careful not to let any water drip onto or into the machine.
4. Maintenance
349
Cleaning the machine
9
Cleaning the inside
During the printing process, paper, toner, and dust particles can accumulate inside the machine. This buildup can cause print quality problems, such as toner specks
or smearing. Cleaning the inside of the machine clears and reduces these problems.
• To prevent damage to the toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes. Cover it with a piece of paper, if necessary.
• Do not touch the green area of the toner cartridge. Use the handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area.
• Use a dry lint free cloth when cleaning the inside of the machine, be careful not to damage the transfer roller or any other inside parts. Do not use solvents such
as benzene or thinner. Printing quality problems can occur and cause damage to the machine.
• Use a dry lint-free cloth to clean the machine.
• Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for the machine to cool down. If your machine has a power switch, turn the power switch off before
cleaning the machine.
• Illustrations on this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page 21).
4. Maintenance
350
Cleaning the machine
4. Maintenance
351
Cleaning the machine
10
Cleaning the pickup roller
• Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for the machine to cool down. If your machine has a power switch, turn the power switch off before
cleaning the machine.
• Illustrations on this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page 21).
4. Maintenance
352
Cleaning the machine
11
Cleaning the scan unit
Keeping the scan unit clean helps ensure the best possible copies. We suggest that you clean the scan unit at the start of each day and during the day as needed.
• Turn the machine off and unplug the power cord. Wait for the machine to cool down. If your machine has a power switch, turn the power switch off before
cleaning the machine.
• Illustrations on this user’s guide may differ from your machine depending on its options or models. Check your machine type (see "Front view" on page 21).
1
2
Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.
Lift and open the scanner lid.
4. Maintenance
353
Cleaning the machine
3
Wipe the surface of the scanner until it is clean and dry.
1
2
3
4
4
Scanner lid
Scanner glass
Document feeder glass
White bar
Close the scanner lid.
4. Maintenance
354
Tips for storing machine, supplies, and paper
•
Keep them in a cool place with no humidity.
•
Keep them covered so that dusts cannot be accumulated.
•
Keep them out of water.
12
Machine
•
•
When moving the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down. Otherwise, the
inside of the machine may be contaminated by toner, which can cause
damage to the machine or reduce print quality.
When moving the machine, make sure at least two people are holding the
machine securely.
14
Paper
•
Store print media in its ream wrapper until you are ready to use it.
•
Place cartons on pallets or shelves, not on the floor.
•
Do not place heavy objects on top of the paper, whether it is packed or
unpacked.
•
Keep it away from moisture or other conditions that can cause it to wrinkle
or curl.
•
Keep it in a temperatures between 15°C ~30°C and humidity between 10%
~ 70%.
13
Toner cartridge/ Imaging unit
To get the best, print quality from the toner cartridge, keep the following
guidelines in mind:
•
Do not remove the toner cartridge from its package until it’s ready to use.
•
Do not refill the toner cartridge. The machine warranty does not cover
damage caused by using a refilled cartridge.
•
Store toner cartridges in the same environment as your machine.
•
Keep it in a stable place so the toner dust is not slanted to one side.
4. Maintenance
355
Tips for moving the machine
•
• When moving the machine, do not subject the control panel to hard
impacts as this may damage the screen or border of the control panel.
When moving or storing the machine, press the unlock button to fold down
the control panel. The unlock button is located on the top side of the control
panel.
• The warranty does not cover damage from falls or impacts due to the
intentional or unintentional actions of the user.
•
When moving the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down. Otherwise, the
inside of the machine may be contaminated by toner, which can cause
damage to the machine or reduce print quality.
•
When moving the machine, make sure at least two people are holding the
machine securely.
4. Maintenance
356
Printing a demo page
Print a demo page to check the print quality of the machine if you have not used
the machine for sometime.
15
From the machine
See "Report" on page 295.
16
From the SyncThru™ Web Service
See "Information tab" on page 161.
4. Maintenance
357
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
If you have any comments or questions regarding Samsung products, contact
the Samsung customer care center.
Country/Region
Customer Care Center
02-201-24-18
Country/Region
ALGERIA
ARGENTINE
ARMENIA
AUSTRALIA
AUSTRIA
AZERBAIJAN
Customer Care Center
BANGLADESH
www.samsung.com/
be/support (Dutch)
BELGIUM
021 36 11 00
www.samsung.com/
n_africa/support
0800-333-3733
www.samsung.com/
ar/support
BOLIVIA
0-800-05-555
www.samsung.com/
support
BOSNIA
1300 362 603
www.samsung.com/
au/support
BOTSWANA
0800 - SAMSUNG (0800 7267864)
www.samsung.com/
at/support
0-88-555-55-55
www.samsung.com/
support
8000-GSAM (8000-4726)
www.samsung.com/
ae/support (English)
BULGARIA
www.samsung.com/
ae_ar/support (Arabic)
BURUNDI
810-800-500-55-500
www.samsung.com/
support
CAMEROON
09612300300
www.samsung.com/
in/support
BAHRAIN
BELARUS
WebSite
BRAZIL
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
be_fr/support (French)
800-10-7260
www.samsung.com/
cl/support
[HHP] 4828210
051 331 999
www.samsung.com/
support
8007260000
www.samsung.com/
support
0800-124-421 (Demais cidades e
regiões)
www.samsung.com/
br/support
4004-0000 (Capitais e grandes
centros)
800 111 31 , Безплатна
телефонна линия
www.samsung.com/
bg/support
200
www.samsung.com/
support
7095- 0077
www.samsung.com/
africa_fr/support
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
358
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
Customer Care Center
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
CANADA
CHILE
CHINA
COLOMBIA
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
[HHP] 02-24828200
www.samsung.com/
ca/support(English)
CYPRUS
www.samsung.com/
ca_fr/support (French)
CZECH
www.samsung.com/
cl/support
DENMARK
www.samsung.com/
cn/support
Bogotá 600 12 72Gratis desde
cualquier parte del país 01 8000
112 112 ó desde su celular
#SAM(726)
www.samsung.com/
co/support
DOMINICA
0-800-507-7267
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
DRC
COSTA RICA
Cote D’ Ivoire
Country/Region
400-810-5858
00-800-1-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
CROATIA
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
072 726 786
www.samsung.com/
hr/support
8000 0077
www.samsung.com/
africa_fr/support
Customer Care Center
8009 4000 only from landline, toll
free
www.samsung.com/
gr/support
800-SAMSUNG (800-726786)
www.samsung.com/
cz/support
70 70 19 70
www.samsung.com/
dk/support
1-800-751-2676
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
499999
www.samsung.com/
support
1-800-10-72670
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
1-800-SAMSUNG (72-6786)
ECUADOR
EGYPT
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/
support(English)
08000-726786
16580
www.samsung.com/
eg/support
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
359
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
EIRE
Customer Care Center
0818 717100
800-6225
EL SALVADOR
ESTONIA
FINLAND
FRANCE
www.samsung.com/
ie/support
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
800-7267
www.samsung.com/
ee/support
030-6227 515
www.samsung.com/fi/
support
01 48 63 00 00
www.samsung.com/
fr/support
0180 6 7267864*
www.samsung.com/
de/support
GHANA
GREECE
Customer Care Center
0800-10077
80111-SAMSUNG (80111 726
7864) only from land line(+30)
210 6897691 from mobile and
land line
www.samsung.com/
gr/support
1-800-299-0013
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
1-800-299-0033
GUATEMALA
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
800-2791-9267
800-2791-9111
HONDURAS
0-800-555-555
www.samsung.com/
support
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
(852) 3698 4698
HONG KONG
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
africa_en/support
0302-200077
[HHP] 0180 6 M SAMSUNG bzw.
0180 6 67267864* (*0,20 €/Anruf
aus dem dt. Festnetz, aus dem
Mobilfunk max. 0,60 €/Anruf)
GEORGIA
Country/Region
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
0180 6 SAMSUNG bzw.
GERMANY
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
hk/support (Chinese)
www.samsung.com/
hk_en/support
(English)
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
360
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
HUNGARY
INDIA
INDONESIA
IRAN
ITALIA
JAMAICA
JAPAN
Customer Care Center
0680SAMSUNG (0680-726786)0680PREMIUM (0680-773648)
www.samsung.com/
hu/support
1800 3000 8282 - Toll Free1800
266 8282 - Toll Free
www.samsung.com/
in/support
021-56997777
www.samsung.com/
id/support
08001128888
021-8255
KAZAKHSTAN
www.samsung.com/
iran/support
www.samsung.com/
it/support
1-800-234-7267
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
0120-363-905
Country/Region
KENYA
www.samsung.com/
jp/support
06 5777444
www.samsung.com/
levant/support
(English)
8-10-800-500-55-500 (GSM:7799,
VIP care 7700)
www.samsung.com/
support
Customer Care Center
LATVIA
LITHUANIA
LUXEMBURG
MACAU
MACEDONIA
www.samsung.com/
support
183-CALL (183-2255)
www.samsung.com/
ae/support (English)
www.samsung.com/
ae_ar/support (Arabic)
8-10-800-500-55-500
www.samsung.com/
kz_ru/support
8000-7267
www.samsung.com/
lv/support
8-800-77777
www.samsung.com/
lt/support
261 03 710
www.samsung.com/
support
0800 333
www.samsung.com/
support
023 207 777
1800-88-9999
MALAYSIA
MEXICO
WebSite
0800 545 545
KUWAIT
KYRGYZSTAN
800-SAMSUNG
(800.7267864)[HHP]
800.Msamsung (800.67267864)
0800-22273
JORDAN
WebSite
603-77137477 (Overseas
contact)
01-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
www.samsung.com/
my/support
www.samsung.com/
mx/support
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
361
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
MOLDOVA
MONGOLIA
MONTENEGRO
MOROCCO
MOZAMBIQUE
MYANMAR
NAMIBIA
Customer Care Center
WebSite
0-800-614-40
www.samsung.com/
support
7-495-363-17-00
www.samsung.com/
support
020 405 888
www.samsung.com/
support
080 100 2255
Country/Region
001-800-5077267
NORWAY
www.samsung.com/
support
01-2399888
www.samsung.com/
support
08 197 267 864
www.samsung.com/
support
0800-726-7864
www.samsung.com/
africa_en/support
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
815 56480
www.samsung.com/
no/support
800-SAMSUNG (800 - 726 7864)
www.samsung.com/
ae/support (English)
OMAN
PAKISTAN
www.samsung.com/
ae_ar/support (Arabic)
0800-Samsung (72678)
www.samsung.com/
pk/support
800-7267
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
800-0101
NIGERIA
NETHERLANDS
NEW ZEALAND
0900-SAMSUNG (0900-7267864)
(€ 0,10/Min)
www.samsung.com/
nl/support
0800 726 786
www.samsung.com/
nz/support
PANAMA
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
latin/support(Spanish)
NICARAGUA
www.samsung.com/
n_africa/support
847267864 / 827267864
Customer Care Center
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
362
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
Customer Care Center
009-800-542-0001
PHILIPPINES
POLAND
PORTUGAL
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
RWANDA
www.samsung.com/
pe/support
ROMANIA
1-800-10-7267864 [PLDT]1-8008-7267864 [Globe landline and
Mobile]02-4222111 [Other
landline]
www.samsung.com/
ph/support
RUSSIA
0 801-172-678* lub +48 22 60793-33 *[HHP] 0 801-672-678* lub
+48 22 607-93-33** (koszt
połączenia według taryfy
operatora)
www.samsung.com/
pl/support
0-800-777-08
808 20 7267
www.samsung.com/
pt/support
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
Customer Care Center
800-CALL (800-2255)
QATAR
1-800-682-3180
PUERTO RICO
Country/Region
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
PARAGUAY
PERU
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
ae/support (English)
www.samsung.com/
ae_ar/support (Arabic)
9999
www.samsung.com/
support
08008 726 78 64 (08008
SAMSUNG )Apel GRATUIT
www.samsung.com/
ro/support
8-800-555-55-55
www.samsung.com/
ru/support
920021230
www.samsung.com/
sa/support
SAUDI ARABIA
SENEGAL
SERBIA
SINGAPORE
SLOVENIA
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
sa_en/support
(English)/
800-00-0077
www.samsung.com/
africa_fr/support
011 321 6899
www.samsung.com/
rs/support
1800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
www.samsung.com/
sg/support
080 697 267090 726 786
www.samsung.com/
rs/si
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
363
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
SLOVAKIA
SOUTH AFRICA
SPAIN
SRI LANKA
SUDAN
SWEDEN
SWITZERLAND
Customer Care Center
www.samsung.com/
sk/support
TANZANIA
0860 SAMSUNG (726 7864)
www.samsung.com/
support
THAILAND
0034902172678[HHP]
0034902167267
www.samsung.com/
es/support
00941175405400094115900000
www.samsung.com/
support
www.samsung.com/
support
0771 726 7864 (SAMSUNG)
www.samsung.com/
se/support
TURKEY
0800 726 78 64 (0800-SAMSUNG) www.samsung.com/
ch/support (German)
TUNISIA
www.samsung.com/
ch_fr/support (French)
8-10-800-500-55-500
0800-329999
UK
www.samsung.com/
support
U.S.A
-Consummer
WebSite
0800 755 755
www.samsung.com/
support
0-2689-3232,1800-29-3232
www.samsung.com/
th/support
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
www.samsung.com/
latin/support
(Spanish)
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/support
(English)
444 77 11
www.samsung.com/
tr/support
80-1000-12 www.samsung.com/
n_africa/support
800-SAMSUNG (800 -726 7864)
www.samsung.com/
ae/support (English)
U.A.E
www.samsung.com/
levant/support
(English)
www.samsung.com/
tw/support
Customer Care Center
TRINIDAD &
TOBAGO
1969
SYRIA
TAIWAN
Country/Region
0800 - SAMSUNG(0800-726 786)
18252273
TADJIKISTAN
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
ae_ar/support (Arabic)
0330 SAMSUNG (7267864)
www.samsung.com/
uk/support
1-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
www.samsung.com/
us/support
Electonics
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
364
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
Country/Region
U.S.A (Mobile
Phones)
UGANDA
Customer Care Center
1-800-SAMSUNG (72-6786)
[HHP] 1-888-987-HELP(4357)
www.samsung.com/
support
0-800-502-000
www.samsung.com/
ua/support (Ukrainian)
www.samsung.com/
ua_ru/support
(Russian)
000- 405-437-33
URUGUAY
VENEZUELA
VIETNAM
ZAMBIA
www.samsung.com/
us/support
0800 300 300
UKRAINE
UZBEKISTAN
WebSite
www.samsung.com/
latin/support(Spanish)
www.samsung.com/
latin_en/
support(English)
8-10-800-500-55-500
www.samsung.com/
support
0-800-SAMSUNG (726-7864)
www.samsung.com/
ve/support
1800 588 889
www.samsung.com/
vn/support
0211 350370
www.samsung.com/
support
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide
365
Glossary
ADF
The following glossary helps you get familiar with the product by
understanding the terminologies commonly used with printing as well as
mentioned in this user’s guide.
802.11
802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN)
communication, developed by the IEEE LAN/MAN Standards Committee (IEEE
802).
802.11b/g/n
802.11b/g/n can share same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band. 802.11b
supports bandwidth up to 11 Mbps, 802.11n supports bandwidth up to 150
Mbps. 802.11b/g/n devices may occasionally suffer interference from
microwave ovens, cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices.
An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a scanning unit that will automatically
feed an original sheet of paper so that the machine can scan some amount of the
paper at once.
AppleTalk
AppleTalk is a proprietary suite of protocols developed by Apple, Inc for
computer networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is
now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.
BIT Depth
A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to represent the
color of a single pixel in a bitmapped image. Higher color depth gives a broader
range of distinct colors. As the number of bits increases, the number of possible
colors becomes impractically large for a color map. 1-bit color is commonly
called as monochrome or black and white.
Access point
Access Point or Wireless Access Point (AP or WAP) is a device that connects
wireless communication devices together on wireless local area networks
(WLAN), and acts as a central transmitter and receiver of WLAN radio signals.
BMP
A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows
graphics subsystem (GDI), and used commonly as a simple graphics file format
on that platform.
Glossary
366
Glossary
BOOTP
Coverage
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to obtain its IP
address automatically. This is usually done in the bootstrap process of
computers or operating systems running on them. The BOOTP servers assign
the IP address from a pool of addresses to each client. BOOTP enables 'diskless
workstation' computers to obtain an IP address prior to loading any advanced
operating system.
It is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing. For
example, 5% coverage means that an A4 sided paper has about 5% image or text
on it. So, if the paper or original has complicated images or lots of text on it, the
coverage will be higher and at the same time, a toner usage will be as much as
the coverage.
CSV
CCD
Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan job. CCD
Locking mechanism is also used to hold the CCD module to prevent any damage
when you move the machine.
Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to exchange
data between disparate applications. The file format, as it is used in Microsoft
Excel, has become a de facto standard throughout the industry, even among
non-Microsoft platforms.
Collation
DSDF
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When collation is
selected, the device prints an entire set before printing additional copies.
A Dual Scan Document Feeder (DSDF) is a scanning unit that will automatically
feed and turn over an original sheet of paper so that the machine can scan on
both sides of the paper.
Control Panel
Default
A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or monitoring
instruments are displayed. They are typically found in front of the machine.
The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box state,
reset, or initialized.
Glossary
367
Glossary
DHCP
DPI
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server networking
protocol. A DHCP server provides configuration parameters specific to the DHCP
client host requesting, generally, information required by the client host to
participate on an IP network. DHCP also provides a mechanism for allocation of
IP addresses to client hosts.
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for scanning and
printing. Generally, higher DPI results in a higher resolution, more visible detail
in the image, and a larger file size.
DIMM
Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone company
service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to answer several
different telephone numbers.
Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds memory.
DIMM stores all the data within the machine like printing data, received fax data.
DRPD
Duplex
DLNA
The Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a standard that allows devices on
a home network to share information with each other across the network.
A mechanism that will automatically turn over a sheet of paper so that the
machine can print (or scan) on both sides of the paper. A printer equipped with
a Duplex Unit can print on both sides of paper during one print cycle.
DNS
Duty Cycle
The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information associated
with domain names in a distributed database on networks, such as the Internet.
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer performance for a
month. Generally the printer has the lifespan limitation such as pages per year.
The lifespan means the average capacity of print-outs, usually within the
warranty period. For example, if the duty cycle is 48,000 pages per month
assuming 20 working days, a printer limits 2,400 pages a day.
Dot Matrix Printer
A dot matrix printer refers to a type of computer printer with a print head that
runs back and forth on the page and prints by impact, striking an ink-soaked
cloth ribbon against the paper, much like a typewriter.
Glossary
368
Glossary
ECM
EtherTalk
Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into Class 1
fax machines or fax modems. It automatically detects and corrects errors in the
fax transmission process that are sometimes caused by telephone line noise.
A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer networking. It
was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now deprecated by Apple
in favor of TCP/IP networking.
Emulation
FDI
Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as another.
Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the machine to allow a
third party device such as a coin operated device or a card reader. Those devices
allow the pay-for-print service on your machine.
An emulator duplicates the functions of one system with a different system, so
that the second system behaves like the first system. Emulation focuses on exact
reproduction of external behavior, which is in contrast to simulation, which
concerns an abstract model of the system being simulated, often considering its
internal state.
Ethernet
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local area
networks (LANs). It defines wiring and signaling for the physical layer, and frame
formats and protocols for the media access control (MAC)/data link layer of the
OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized as IEEE 802.3. It has become the most
widespread LAN technology in use during the 1990s to the present.
FTP
A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for exchanging files
over any network that supports the TCP/IP protocol (such as the Internet or an
intranet).
Fuser Unit
The part of a laser printer that fuses the toner onto the print media. It consists of
a heat roller and a pressure roller. After toner is transferred onto the paper, the
fuser unit applies heat and pressure to ensure that the toner stays on the paper
permanently, which is why paper is warm when it comes out of a laser printer.
Glossary
369
Glossary
Gateway
IEEE
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer network
and a telephone line. It is very popular, as it is a computer or a network that
allows access to another computer or network.
The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an international
non-profit, professional organization for the advancement of technology
related to electricity.
Grayscale
IEEE 1284
A shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of an image when color
images are converted to grayscale; colors are represented by various shades of
gray.
The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of Electrical and
Electronics Engineers (IEEE). The term "1284-B" refers to a specific connector
type on the end of the parallel cable that attaches to the peripheral (for example,
a printer).
Halftone
Intranet
An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots. Highly
colored areas consist of a large number of dots, while lighter areas consist of a
smaller number of dots.
Mass storage device (HDD)
Mass storage device (HDD), commonly referred to as a hard drive or hard disk, is
a non-volatile storage device which stores digitally-encoded data on rapidly
rotating platters with magnetic surfaces.
A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and
possibly the public telecommunication system to securely share part of an
organization's information or operations with its employees. Sometimes the
term refers only to the most visible service, the internal website.
IP address
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in order to
identify and communicate with each other on a network utilizing the Internet
Protocol standard.
Glossary
370
Glossary
IPM
ITU-T
The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a way of measuring the speed of a printer. An IPM
rate indicates the number of single-sided sheets a printer can complete within
one minute.
The International Telecommunication Union is an international organization
established to standardize and regulate international radio and
telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization, allocation of the
radio spectrum, and organizing interconnection arrangements between
different countries to allow international phone calls. A -T out of ITU-T indicates
telecommunication.
IPP
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing as
well as managing print jobs, media size, resolution, and so forth. IPP can be used
locally or over the Internet to hundreds of printers, and also supports access
control, authentication, and encryption, making it a much more capable and
secure printing solution than older ones.
ITU-T No. 1 chart
Standardized test chart published by ITU-T for document facsimile
transmissions.
IPX/SPX
JBIG
IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet Exchange. It is a
networking protocol used by the Novell NetWare operating systems. IPX and
SPX both provide connection services similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol
having similarities to IP, and SPX having similarities to TCP. IPX/SPX was
primarily designed for local area networks (LANs), and is a very efficient protocol
for this purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN).
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression standard with
no loss of accuracy or quality, which was designed for compression of binary
images, particularly for faxes, but can also be used on other images.
ISO
JPEG
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used standard
method of lossy compression for photographic images. It is the format used for
storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide Web.
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an international
standard-setting body composed of representatives from national standards
bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and commercial standards.
Glossary
371
Glossary
LDAP
MH
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking protocol for
querying and modifying directory services running over TCP/IP.
Modified Huffman (MH) is a compression method for decreasing the amount of
data that needs to be transmitted between the fax machines to transfer the
image recommended by ITU-T T.4. MH is a codebook-based run-length
encoding scheme optimized to efficiently compress white space. As most faxes
consist mostly of white space, this minimizes the transmission time of most
faxes.
LED
A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates the status
of a machine.
MMR
MAC address
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated with a
network adapter. MAC address is a unique 48-bit identifier usually written as 12
hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e. g., 00-00-0c-34-11-4e). This address
is usually hard-coded into a Network Interface Card (NIC) by its manufacturer,
and used as an aid for routers trying to locate machines on large networks.
Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method recommended by ITUT T.6.
Modem
A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information, and also
demodulates such a carrier signal to decode transmitted information.
MFP
MR
Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office machine that includes the following
functionality in one physical body, so as to have a printer, a copier, a fax, a
scanner and etc.
Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T T.4. MR
encodes the first scanned line using MH. The next line is compared to the first,
the differences determined, and then the differences are encoded and
transmitted.
Glossary
372
Glossary
NetWare
OSI
A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used
cooperative multitasking to run various services on a PC, and the network
protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS stack. Today NetWare
supports TCP/IP as well as IPX/SPX.
Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the International
Organization for Standardization (ISO) for communications. OSI offers a
standard, modular approach to network design that divides the required set of
complex functions into manageable, self-contained, functional layers. The layers
are, from top to bottom, Application, Presentation, Session, Transport, Network,
Data Link and Physical.
OPC
Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual image for
print using a laser beam emitted from a laser printer, and it is usually green or
rust colored and has a cylinder shape.
An imaging unit containing a drum slowly wears the drum surface by its usage
in the printer, and it should be replaced appropriately since it gets worn from
contact with the cartridge development brush, cleaning mechanism, and paper.
Originals
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text, etc,
which is copied, reproduced or translated to produce others, but which is not
itself copied or derived from something else.
PABX
A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone
switching system within a private enterprise.
PCL
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language (PDL)
developed by HP as a printer protocol and has become an industry standard.
Originally developed for early inkjet printers, PCL has been released in varying
levels for thermal, dot matrix printer, and laser printers.
PDF
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed by
Adobe Systems for representing two dimensional documents in a device
independent and resolution independent format.
Glossary
373
Glossary
PostScript
Protocol
PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming language used
primarily in the electronic and desktop publishing areas. - that is run in an
interpreter to generate an image.
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection,
communication, and data transfer between two computing endpoints.
PS
Printer Driver
See PostScript.
A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer to the
printer.
Print Media
The media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can be used
in a printer, a scanner, a fax or, a copier.
PSTN
The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the world's
public circuit-switched telephone networks which, on industrial premises, is
usually routed through the switchboard.
RADIUS
PPM
Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining how fast
a printer works, meaning the number of pages a printer can produce in one
minute.
Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS) is a protocol for remote
user authentication and accounting. RADIUS enables centralized management
of authentication data such as usernames and passwords using an AAA
(authentication, authorization, and accounting) concept to manage network
access.
PRN file
Resolution
An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the device
driver using standard input/output system calls, which simplifies many tasks.
The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The higher the dpi,
the greater the resolution.
Glossary
374
Glossary
SMB
TCP/IP
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to share files,
printers, serial ports, and miscellaneous communications between nodes on a
network. It also provides an authenticated Inter-process communication
mechanism.
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP); the set of
communications protocols that implement the protocol stack on which the
Internet and most commercial networks run.
TCR
SMTP
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail transmissions
across the Internet. SMTP is a relatively simple, text-based protocol, where one
or more recipients of a message are specified, and then the message text is
transferred. It is a client-server protocol, where the client transmits an email
message to the server.
SSID
Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name of a wireless local area network (WLAN). All
wireless devices in a WLAN use the same SSID in order to communicate with
each other. The SSIDs are case-sensitive and have a maximum length of 32
characters.
Transmission Confirmation Report (TCR) provides details of each transmission
such as job status, transmission result and number of pages sent. This report can
be set to print after each job or only after failed transmissions.
TIFF
Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bitmapped image
format. TIFF describes image data that typically come from scanners. TIFF
images make use of tags, keywords defining the characteristics of the image that
is included in the file. This flexible and platform-independent format can be
used for pictures that have been made by various image processing
applications.
Toner Cartridge
Subnet Mask
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to determine
which part of the address is the network address and which part is the host
address.
A kind of bottle or container used in a machine like a printer which contains
toner. Toner is a powder used in laser printers and photocopiers, which forms
the text and images on the printed paper. Toner can be fused by by a
combination of heat/pressure from the fuser, causing it to bind to the fibers in
the paper.
Glossary
375
Glossary
TWAIN
Watermark
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAIN-compliant
scanner with a TWAIN-compliant program, a scan can be initiated from within
the program. It is an image capture API for Microsoft Windows and Apple
Macintosh operating systems.
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears lighter
when viewed by transmitted light. Watermarks were first introduced in Bologna,
Italy in 1282; they have been used by papermakers to identify their product, and
also on postage stamps, currency, and other government documents to
discourage counterfeiting.
UNC Path
WEP
Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network shares
in Window NT and other Microsoft products. The format of a UNC path is:
\\<servername>\<sharename>\<Additional directory>
URL
Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents and
resources on the Internet. The first part of the address indicates what protocol to
use, the second part specifies the IP address or the domain name where the
resource is located.
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is a security protocol specified in IEEE 802.11 to
provide the same level of security as that of a wired LAN. WEP provides security
by encrypting data over radio so that it is protected as it is transmitted from one
end point to another.
WIA
Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is originally
introduced in Windows Me and Windows XP. A scan can be initiated from within
these operating systems by using a WIA-compliant scanner.
USB
WPA
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the USB
Implementers Forum, Inc., to connect computers and peripherals. Unlike the
parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a single computer USB
port to multiple peripherals.
Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA) is a class of systems to secure wireless (Wi-Fi)
computer networks, which was created to improve upon the security features of
WEP.
Glossary
376
Glossary
WPA-PSK
WPA-PSK (WPA Pre-Shared Key) is special mode of WPA for small business or
home users. A shared key, or password, is configured in the wireless access point
(WAP) and any wireless laptop or desktop devices. WPA-PSK generates a unique
key for each session between a wireless client and the associated WAP for more
advanced security.
WPS
The Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) is a standard for establishing a wireless home
network. If your wireless access point supports WPS, you can configure the
wireless network connection easily without a computer.
XPS
XML Paper Specification (XPS) is a specification for a Page Description Language
(PDL) and a new document format, which has benefits for portable document
and electronic document, developed by Microsoft. It is an XML-based
specification, based on a new print path and a vector-based deviceindependent document format.
Glossary
377
Index
A
authority
accessories
B
installing
237
ordering
235
accounting
164
address book
162
group
162
inividual
162
adjusting
altitude
281, 286
AirPrint
340
alerts
161
altitude adjustment
281, 286
customer support
booklet printing
75
booklets
75
163
setting a fax header
checking stored document
348
tray setting
viewing
294
authentication
login
289
160, 280
147
349
demo page
357
pickup roller
352
device options
237
scan unit
353
direct printing utility
82
349
display screen
23
connect
294
address book
outside
293
uninstalling
59
350
application
293
135
inside
167
managing
292
deleting
cleaning
AnyWeb Print
294
default paper selection
certificate
cleaning a machine
installing
302
default settings
137
294
143
D
printing
C
answering machine/fax
enable/disable
126,
164
printer cable
displaying
24
IP address
control panel
23
document box
convention
14
copy
setting
understanding the document
box screen
162
copying
basic copying
103, 116
understanding the copy screen
94, 108,
307
181
document feeder
47
driver installation
312
Unix
317
duplex printing
Index 378
Index
print
76
E
easy document creator
e-book conversion
118, 169
169
editing
changing the receive mode
137
IPv6
164
in answering machine/fax
137, 139
MAC
163, 164
secure receiving
138, 139
network
fax sending
136
resending automatically
136
sending a fax
135
147
individual address
146
error correction mode
140
error message
208
ethernet
306
changing receiving mode
external authentication server
164
F
favorites settings, for printing
73
fax
firmware
delay sending
group address
fax, email
individual address
311
165
front view 1
21
G
general icons
145
faxing
general settings
14
281, 282, 287, 295, 297
glossary
366
137
google cloud printing
341
delaying a fax transmission
136
group
forwarding
139
preparing to fax
123
receiving
137
H
receiving a fax in memory
139
HTTP settings
137
group address
146
163
address book
162
receiving in Ans/Fax mode
clearing stored documents
348
receiving in Tel mode
137
I
forward
141
sending
135
id copy
prefix dial
140
setting the fax header
135
inner view
22
IPP settings
162
printing
secure receive
toll save
fax receiving
141
141
140, 141
features
print media feature
printer driver
filtering
6
105
249
63
164
J
jam
Index 379
Index
clearing jam
192
in the document feeder
47
address book
tips for avoiding paper jams
191
originals on the scanner glass
45
application
paper in multi-purpose tray
52
user
paper in the tray1
50
managing USB memory
special media
55
margin
JPEG
USB scanning memory device
145, 150
K
log
keyboard
understanding the keyboard
login
38
LPR/LPD settings
L
M
LED
Mac
machine status
understanding the status LED
link
26, 28
26
165
Linux
common Linux problems
160, 280
229
316
230
348
memory upgrading
239
356
loading
52
tips on using
52
using special media
55
317
connected
43
N
printing
87
network
scanning
120
authentication
289
system requirements
254
driver installation
Linux
Mac
UNIX
Windows
317
316
317
312
89
printing
89
mac scanning
120
scanning
121
machine detail
301
system requirements
255
machine protocols
310
121
maintenance parts
236
loading
292
multi-purpose tray
driver installation for network
connected
244
clearing memory
moving
common Mac problems
164
memory
162
printer properties
linux scanning
printing
165, 293
driver reinstallation for USB cable
driver installation for network
connected
165
162
managing
installing environment
256, 304
Index 380
Index
SetIP program
323
poster, print
setting up
304
postScript driver
wireless network setup
320
network filtering
311
N-up printing
Windows
power save
74
87
O
84
231
changing the print percentage
77
284
duplex
mobile OS
338
a selected paper size
77
mobileprint
338
Linux
89
Mac
87
print media
58
margin
envelope
56
multiple pages on one sheet of paper
Mac
Windows
guidelines
49
ordering
235
labels
57
output support
47
45
overlay printing
249
paper tab in printer preferences
68
preprinted paper
58
setting the paper size
59
setting the paper type
59
55
create
80
special media
delete
81
printer preferences
print
81
Linux
89
printer properties
P
opening printer preferences
paper size
59
paper type
60
162, 292
card stock
235
loading
in the document feeder
on the scanner glass
162, 292
fitting your document to
optional tray
original document
printing
changing the default print settings
print
n-up printing
Mac
troubleshooting
74
66
printer status
general information
173
87
74
network printing
309
paper orientation
162, 292
poster
74
printing a document
Windows
64
printing on both sides of paper
Mac
Windows
88
76
printing to a file
86
setting as a default machine
85
UNIX
91
using direct printing utility
82
using overlay
80
Index 381
Index
using watermarks
printing a document
295
requirements
Linux
89
Mac
87
UNIX
91
SyncThruTM Web Service
227
problems
system
163
security settings
159
S
safety
problem
operating system problems
demo page
78
user authentication
289
serial number
347
server settings
303
service contact numbers
358
323
information
15
SetIP program
symbols
15
settings
copying problems
223
samsung printer experience
175
copy
162
faxing problems
225
Samsung Printer Status
173
current
161
paper feeding problems
214
scan
DNS
306
power problems
213
ethernet
306
printing quality problems
218
scanner
fax
162
scanning problems
224
glass
45
gernal
touch screen
214
loading documents
45
HTTP
163
machine
162
loading documents
104
rear view
45
margin
network
scanning
281, 282, 287, 295, 297
162, 292
162, 303, 306
Linux scanning
121
printer
162
Mac
120
scan
162
162
TWAIN
117
22
searching
security
network
163
163
147
server
303
server for printing
309
R
Raw TCP/IP settings
162
scanner glass
Q
quick copy
email server
regulatiory information
257
report
295
address book
security
Index 382
Index
sound
283
connecting to
159
replacing the cartridge
187
SyncThruTM Web Service
163
copy
162
replacing toner
346
TCP/IPv4
306
external authentication server
164
sending a toner notification
345
tray
282
fax
162
WINS
307
information tab
161
sound
283
log
165
specifications
247
maintenance tab
165
print media
249
network
162
348
printer
162
auto continue
60
requirements
159
loading paper in multi-purpose tray
52
stored documents
storing
toner unit
sending the toner reorder notification 345
touch screen
problem solving
214
tray
machine
355
scan
162
ordering an optional tray
paper
355
security tab
163
paper substitution
60
supplies
355
settings
161
setting the paper size and type
59
settings tab
162
Tray 1
user access control
164
tray setting
282
user profile
164
what is
159
TWAIN, scan
117
supplies
available supplies
monitoring the supplies life
234
344
ordering
234
replacing toner cartridge
187
storing
355
SyncThruTM Web Service
accounting
159
164
235
59
U
T
TCP/IPv4
306
TCP/IPv6
307, 308
address book tab
162
terminology
application management
165
toner cartridge
configuring
163
redistributing toner
277
UNIX
driver installation for network
connected
printing
317
91
Unix
185, 346
system requirements
255
Index 383
Index
usage
common Windows problems
counter
35, 161
supplies
161
driver installation for network
connected
312
driver installation for USB cable
usb
understanding the usb screen
227
242
connected
39
driver reinstallation for USB cable
USB cable
driver installation
39
connected
42
driver reinstallation
43
printing
62
scanning
107
USB Drive
how to manage
244
system requirements
253
printing
243
using SetIP
323
wireless
user
managing
164
profile
164
user access control
using help
164
73, 88
WPS
disconnecting
322
wireless network
network cable
WSD settings
323
162
W
watermark
create
78
delete
79
edit
79
print
78
Windows
Index 384